八年级英语下册课件
发布时间:2024-08-22 八年级英语下册课件 八年级英语课件八年级英语下册课件。
以下是幼儿教师教育网小编整理的“八年级英语下册课件”类希望对大家有所帮助。教案课件是老师在课堂上非常重要的课件,因此就需要我们老师写好属于自己教学课件。教师的成功备课离不开完备的教案。如果您觉得这篇文章有参考价值请别忘了把这篇文章收藏下来!
八年级英语下册课件【篇1】
When you play things, you must get good corporation with your players.
教学重点、难点:
1、I am throwing the basketball.
教具、学具:
some balls and story a tape and pictures
Review “ past tense” and “ future tense” verbs with a game. Write three columns of words on the blackboard and ask for volunteers to match them correctly. As each student makes a match, he or she says “Yesterday IXXXde. Today IXXX. Tomorrow I am going toXX.
Add “buy” “teach” and “think” to your “today” column. Ask the students to give you the future tense for each verb and write them under your “tomorrow” column. Then write “taught” “thought” “bought” in a different order than the other two columns, and ask the students to guess how they match with the present-tense verbs. Point out the similarities in spelling “bought” “taught” “thought”
Pause after Number 1 in the student book. Review the story so far. Today Jenny and Li Ming went to the store buy some clothes for Li Ming to the pictures in the student book. Who are they talking to
Note the word “player” in the lesson. A “players” plays something, such as a sport.
Play “What’s wrong” to practice the new past tense verbs, and other tenses and verbs.
Play “spelling Bee” to practice spelling any vocabulary in this unit.
Tech “Oh, what did you do” in Number 3 of the student book.
Number 2 in the activity book is a listening exercise. The students listen to each sentence on the audiotape and change it into the past—tense. Here’s how the audiotape goes:
八年级英语下册课件【篇2】
教案:
教学主题:第二单元英语第二课
教学目标:
1. 学会问候语,如 Hello 和 Good morning/afternoon/evening 等。
2. 学会介绍自己,如 My name is \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_. I am \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_ years old. I am \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_. I am from \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_.
3. 学会表达感激之情,如 Thank you 和 Thank you very much 等。
4. 学会描述外貌,如 What is your \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_? How are you?
5. 学会表达喜好,如 What is your favorite \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_? Do you like \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_?
6. 学会表达意见,如 What do you think of \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_? How about \_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_\_?
教学准备:
1. 教材:英语教材
2. 教学资源:图片、视频、音频等
3. 教学工具:黑板、粉笔、教鞭等
4. 教学评估:考试、作业、口头表达等
教学步骤:
1. 引入:通过图片、视频等引入本单元的主题,并简单介绍本课的内容。
2. 知识讲解:通过黑板、PPT等向学生讲解本单元的知识点,并举例说明。
3. 练习巩固:通过练习、作业等方式巩固本单元的知识点,并帮助学生提高听说读写的能力。
4. 小组活动:通过小组讨论、角色扮演等活动,激发学生的学习兴趣,并提高学生的团队合作能力。
5. 总结回顾:总结本单元的知识点,回顾本课的内容,并提醒学生巩固本单元的知识。
教学反思:
本单元的教学旨在帮助学生掌握问候语、介绍自己、表达感激之情、描述外貌、表达喜好和表达意见等知识点,并提高学生的听说读写能力。在教学过程中,我注重了与学生的互动,通过小组活动和提问等方式,激发学生的学习兴趣,并提高了学生的学习效果。在练习巩固的过程中,我注重了学生的反馈,及时纠正学生的错误,并提醒学生巩固本单元的知识。在总结回顾的过程中,我总结了本单元的知识点,并提醒学生巩固本单元的知识。总的来说,本单元的教学效果较好,但也存在一些问题,如部分学生对于问候语的理解和表达能力较差,需要加强练习。
八年级英语下册课件【篇3】
教学目标
一、知识与技能
1. 掌握常用动词的过去分词的拼写形式以及熟练掌握already,yet在现在完成时中的应用。
2. 体会现在完成时在阅读文章《鲁滨逊漂流记》中的应用以及对阅读文章的理解分析。
3. 熟练掌握 already,yet 在现在完成时中的用法。
4. 掌握常用动词的过去分词形式。
5. 使用阅读技巧对阅读文章进行理解与分析。
二、过程与方法
将抽象知识具体化,帮助学生总结规律,系统地学习语法。调动学生的积极性,引导他们积极参与课堂。
三、情感态度与价值观
通过对《鲁宾逊漂流记》节选部分的学习,引导学生在生活和学习中要不抛弃不放弃。
教学重点
1. 体会现在完成时在阅读文章《鲁滨逊漂流记》中的应用以及对阅读文章的理解分析。
2. 熟练掌握already,yet在现在完成时中的用法。
教学难点
1. 使用阅读技巧对阅读文章进行理解与分析。
2. 熟练掌握already,yet在现在完成时中的用法。
教法导航
通过大量练习让学生主动掌握语法知识。
学法导航
练习、讨论、主动探求规律。
教学准备
多媒体。
教学过程
Step 1 Greetings
Greet the students as usual.
Step 2 Presentation
Introduce the movie:Robinson Crusoe.
The teacher shows some introductions on the screen to arouse the students’ interests.
Step 3 Learn the new words
ship,tool,gun,sand,else,cannibal,towards,land.
Step 4 Reading
3a, Read the passage and answer the following questions:
What does Robinson Crusoe wait for?
Why does Robinson Crusoe call the man Friday?
3b, Read the passage again. Find words that have these meanings.
1. You can use these to shoot things: _____
2. Something you use to travel in the sea: _____
3. A piece of land in the middle of the sea: ______
4. You can use these to cut things: ______
5. Signs left behind by someone or something: ______
3c, Correct the sentences:
1. Robinson Crusoe arrived on the island with enough food and drink.
2. Friday made a small boat.
3. Robinson had some food and tools when he first arrived on the island.
4. Robinson used the ship to build a house.
5. Friday saw some marks of another man’s feet on the beach.
6. Robinson tried to kill the two men.
After they finished the questions and let them check the answers.
Then get them read aloud the passage again and the teacher helps deal with the difficult points.
1) I will not give up and I will wait for another ship. 因此我不放弃,要等候另一只船。
another 既可用作形容词,也可用作代词。用作形容词时,意思是“又一的;再一的”,修饰名词,位于名词前;用作代词时,意思是“另一个”。
e.g. Just at that time,another man came in.
Saying is one thing and doing is another.
another还可以和数词连用,常放在数词的前面,意为“还;再;又”。
e.g. We need another three man to help do the work.
2) Not long after that,I saw some cannibals trying to kill two men from a broken ship.
在那之后不久,我看见一些食人肉质在试图杀死两个来自破船上的人。
see sb. doing sth.意为“看到某人正在做某事”,强调看到的动作正在进行。
e.g. Mary saw him cleaning the classroom.
玛丽看见他正在打扫教室。
see sb. do sth. 意为“看到某人做了某事”,强调看到动作的全过程。
e.g. Mary saw him clean the classroom.
玛丽看见他打扫教室了。
3) I named him Friday because that was the day I met him.
我管他叫Friday因为那是我遇见他的那一天。
name作动词,意为“命名;给…取名”。固定搭配“name + sb. + 名字”意为“给某人取名为…”。
e.g. Lucy named her little son David. 露西给她的小儿子取名为戴维。
Step 5 Grammar Focus
Read the following sentences (让学生体会现在完成时的用法)。
师生共同总结出下列内容:
1.表示过去发生或已经完成的某一动作对现在造成的影响或结果。
e.g. ---Have you had your lunch yet?
---Yes,I have. I’ve just had it. (现在我不饿了)
2. 表示动作或状态从过去某一时刻开始,一直延续到现在,而且可能还要继续下去。
e.g. I haven’t seen her these days.
I’ve known Bob for three years.
I’ve been at this school for over two years.
时间状语 already,yet,just,ever,never,before;for + 时间段;since + 过去的时间点;since + 段时间 ago;since + 一般过去时的句子。
构成:现在完成时是由“助动词have /has+ 动词的过去分词”构成的,规则动词的过去分词构成与过去式相同,不规则动词的过去分词则需逐个记忆。
Step 6 Practice
Exercises
1. go through the tasks in 4a and 4b,then finish 4a and check the answers.
Keys:I have just drunk some tea.
Have you found it?
He has already left.
did he leave?
She has already seen the film.
I haven’t told them yet.
2. Finish 4b and check the answers.
Keys:loves,has read,will be,finished,will write,hasn’t read.
3. Finish 4c and check the answers.
Make conversations and complete the chart. (Follow the conversation on page 60)
Step 7 Homework
Sum up what they have learned in this lesson.
课堂作业
用所给单词的适当形式填空。
1. Judy has already _______ (finish) reading Little Women.
2. Tom and Mike have already _______ (decide) to learn Chinese on Internet.
3. Have you ________ (read) Alice in Wonderland yet?
4. Robinson ________ (have) already built a house on the island.
5. It often ________ (snow) in North China in winter.
参考答案:1.finished 2. decided 3. read 4. has; snows
教学反思
教学的目的不仅仅是教给学生知识,而且也要教给他们用所学知识解决问题的能力和技能。为了检查教学活动的效果,要及时对课堂的活动加以总结和评价,使得学生在激励中成长、进步。
八年级英语下册课件【篇4】
八年级下册英语教案
主题一:环保
范文1:How to Protect the Environment
Environmental protection is becoming increasingly important in today's world. As individuals, we all have a responsibility to do our part in protecting the environment. Here are some simple yet effective ways to make a difference.
Firstly, we can start by reducing our use of disposable items. For example, instead of using plastic bags when shopping, we can bring our own reusable bags. This simple change can greatly reduce the amount of plastic waste produced.
Secondly, we should also make an effort to conserve energy. Turning off lights and appliances when they are not in use is a simple step that everyone can take to save electricity. Additionally, using energy-efficient light bulbs and appliances can also make a significant impact.
Thirdly, we should promote the use of public transportation and carpooling. Using public transportation not only reduces air pollution, but also helps to decrease traffic congestion. Carpooling with others can also reduce the number of cars on the road, thus reducing carbon emissions.
Furthermore, we should be mindful of our water consumption. Simple actions such as turning off the tap while brushing our teeth or taking shorter showers can help to conserve water. Additionally, fixing any leaks or drips in our homes can prevent water wastage.
Lastly, we should promote recycling and proper waste disposal. Separating recyclable materials such as paper, plastic, and glass from our regular garbage can greatly reduce the amount of waste that goes into landfills. Additionally, we should avoid littering and always dispose of our trash in designated bins.
In conclusion, it is vital that we all take steps to protect the environment. By following these simple tips, we can make a positive impact on our planet and ensure a better future for generations to come.
主题二:健康生活
范文2:Tips for Maintaining a Healthy Lifestyle
Maintaining a healthy lifestyle is crucial for our overall well-being. Here are some tips for staying healthy.
Firstly, it is important to eat a balanced diet. This means including a variety of fruits, vegetables, whole grains, and lean proteins in our meals. Avoiding excessive sugar, salt, and unhealthy fats can also help to prevent various health problems.
Secondly, regular physical exercise is essential for maintaining a healthy lifestyle. Engaging in activities such as running, swimming, or cycling can improve cardiovascular health and strengthen muscles. It is recommended to aim for at least 30 minutes of exercise most days of the week.
Thirdly, getting enough sleep is equally important. Lack of sleep can negatively affect both our physical and mental health. It is recommended for teenagers to get between 8-10 hours of sleep each night.
Furthermore, it is crucial to manage stress effectively. Chronic stress can lead to a variety of health issues. Engaging in activities such as meditation, yoga, or spending time with loved ones can help to reduce stress levels.
Lastly, it is important to avoid harmful substances such as tobacco, alcohol, and drugs. These substances can have severe negative effects on our health.
In conclusion, maintaining a healthy lifestyle is essential for our well-being. By following these tips, we can ensure a healthier and happier life. Remember, small changes can lead to big improvements in our overall health.
八年级英语下册课件【篇5】
Unfortunately, as an AI language model, I am not able to provide you with a pre-written essay or essay templates, but I can give you some guidance on how to write a theme-based essay on the 8th-grade English textbook.
First, determine the theme of the lesson or chapter. For example, suppose the topic is about environmental protection. Your job is to write about the importance of protecting the environment. Start by conducting research on the topic, gather valuable information from reliable sources, define your thesis statement, and create an outline.
You can start your essay by introducing the topic, highlighting the current environmental issues, and explaining why environmental protection is crucial. You may share some exciting facts or statistics to grab your reader's attention. Then, develop your thesis statement, explaining what you learned about environmental protection from the lesson or chapter.
Next, you can divide your essay into sections, such as the causes and effects of environmental degradation, the role of people in environmental protection, and the steps that individuals can take to contribute to environmental protection.
In the first section, you can discuss the causes of environmental degradation, such as overpopulation, pollution, deforestation, and climate change. You can explain their negative impacts on the environment, such as the extinction of species, global warming, and increase in natural disasters.
In the second section, discuss the role of individuals in environmental protection. Talk about how people can use their daily activities to reduce their carbon footprints, such as conserving energy, using green technologies, and avoiding single-use plastics. You can also touch on the importance of governments, non-governmental organizations, and international coalitions on environmental protection.
In the final section, provide some steps that individuals can take to contribute to environmental protection, such as reducing their waste, conserving water, planting trees, and advocating for environmental policies.
Lastly, you should conclude your essay by summarizing your main points and restating your thesis statement. You can also provide some key takeaways and encourage your readers to take action towards environmental protection.
In summary, writing a theme-based essay on an English textbook requires you to conduct thorough research, establish a clear thesis, develop an outline, and organize your ideas effectively. With the right approach, you can create an informative and insightful essay that demonstrates your understanding of the subject matter.
八年级英语下册课件【篇6】
教学目标:知识目标:1.bought, taught and thought
2.the story
3.a song
能力目标:1. past tense
2.where did you do?
3.What did you do?
情感目标:When you play things, you must get good corporation with your players.
教学重点、难点:1.I am throwing the basketball.
2.hitting and throwing
教具、学具:some balls and story a tape and pictures
教学过程:[==]
一. Class opening and review
Review “ past tense” and “ future tense” verbs with a game. Write three columns of words on the blackboard and ask for volunteers to match them correctly. As each student makes a match, he or she says “Yesterday I___de. Today I___. Tomorrow I am going to__.
Introduce
Add “buy” “teach” and “think” to your “today” column. Ask the students to give you the future tense for each verb and write them under your “tomorrow” column. Then write “taught” “thought” “bought” in a different order than the other two columns, and ask the students to guess how they match with the present-tense verbs. Point out the similarities in spelling “bought” “taught” “thought”
Use the student book
Pause after Number 1 in the student book. Review the story so far. Today Jenny and Li Ming went to the store buy some clothes for Li Ming to the pictures in the student book. Who are they talking to?
Note the word “player” in the lesson. A “players” plays something, such as a sport.
Practice
Play “What’s wrong?” to practice the new past tense verbs, and other tenses and verbs.
Play “spelling Bee” to practice spelling any vocabulary in this unit.
Tech “Oh, what did you do?” in Number 3 of the student book.
Use the activity book
Number 2 in the activity book is a listening exercise. The students listen to each sentence on the audiotape and change it into the past—tense. Here’s how the audiotape goes:
板书:
Lesson4 Where did you go?
bought taught thought
Where did you do?
What did you do?
习题:
? 写出buy teach think 的过去式。
? 用Where did you do?练习说话。
? 用What did you do?练习说话。
八年级英语下册课件【篇7】
教学目标:
1、学生能正确说、读、写、用forget、remember
2、学生能用下列句子进行会话:
Do you remember this? Yes, it is a . (No, I forget.)
教学重点:
1、学生能正确说、读、写、用forget、remember
2、学生能熟练运用下列句子进行会话:
Do you remember this? Yes, it is a . (No, I forget.)
教学难点:学生能用下列句子进行会话:
Do you remember this? Yes, it is a . (No, I forget.)
教 具:词卡、录音机
课 时:1课时
教学过程:
一、问侯:
二、唱歌:
三、操练:复习25课单词
四、教授forget、remember
1、示范:
教师装作忘记然后又想起某物体的英语名称,如:装作忘记怎样说bag
和 book,教师用手势和面部表情让学生看明白意思,指关物体进行下列对话:
师:What is this? I forget how to say it in English. I forget. Say it, please, class.
生:I forget.
师:Oh, I remember. It’s a bag. I remember. Say it, please,class.
生:I remember.
然后,师再指另一件物品,
师:I forget what this is. What’s this? Do you remember?
生:It’s a book.
师:Oh, yes, you remember. Now I remember, too.
2、跟读课文录音:
3、练习:用游戏“Go Fish”的'变化形式做游戏。在游戏中,一生向另一生展示一张卡片并问:Do you remember this? 如对方有这张卡片,便回答:Yes, it is a . 如对方没有这张卡片,则回答No, I forget.
4、角色扮演:
5、《活动手册》 No.1
6、游戏:
五、结束本课教学:
作业:1、熟练本课对话
2、做《活动手册》
板书:
Lesson 26 Looking at Picture
remember forget
Do you remember this?
Yes, it is a .
八年级英语下册课件【篇8】
一、教案
1. 教学目标
a. 知识目标:学习并掌握关于描述人物特征的词汇和句型,如外貌特征、性格特征等。
b. 技能目标:培养学生运用所学词汇和句型进行描述和比较的能力。
c. 情感目标:培养学生的合作意识和团队精神,增强学生的自信心和积极性。
2. 教学重点
a. 学生能够正确运用所学的词汇和句型进行描述人物特征。
b. 学生能够用英语简单描述自己和他人的外貌特征和性格特征。
3. 教学难点
a. 学生能够用比较级和最高级句型对人物进行描述和比较。
b. 学生能够用英语详细描述人物的外貌特征和性格特征。
4. 教学准备
a. 教师准备:PPT课件、教学素材、小组活动准备、课堂展示材料等。
b. 学生准备:学生课本、学习笔记、课堂参与物品等。
5. 教学步骤
a. Step 1: 导入新课
- 呈现一张描述人物特征的照片,引发学生对外貌特征和性格特征的思考和讨论。
- 利用幻灯片展示,引导学生从图片中学习描述人物的词汇和句型。
b. Step 2: 学习新知
- 分组活动:将学生分成小组,每组分一位学生做模特,其他组员描述他的外貌特征和性格特征。组内对比,评选出最佳描述和最佳模特。
- 引导学生运用所学词汇和句型进行描述。
c. Step 3: 讲解语法
- 教师进行比较级和最高级句型的讲解,引导学生掌握运用。
d. Step 4: 实践运用
- 学生完成课本上的习题,对比和评价句子的准确性和描述的详细程度。
e. Step 5: 总结归纳
- 教师对本节课学习的重点、难点进行总结,梳理并提醒学生记忆。
二、反思
本节课的教学目标是学习并掌握描述人物特征的词汇和句型,培养学生描述和比较的能力。通过小组活动、实践运用等多种教学方法,让学生在实践中学习、运用和巩固所学内容。整堂课的教学过程基本顺利,但也存在以下几个问题:
1. 学生参与度不高:在小组活动中,个别学生参与度较低,导致整个小组工作效率不高。需要提前做好激发学生兴趣和参与的准备工作,引导学生积极参与。
2. 难度过高:部分学生对比较级和最高级句型掌握不牢固,导致在实践运用中出现困难。教师在讲解语法时需要使用简单明了的语言,配合具体例子进行解释,帮助学生理解和掌握。
3. 教学资源不足:课堂展示材料不够丰富,限制了学生的视觉体验和思维拓展。教师应准备更多的图片、视频等资源,以刺激学生的学习兴趣和主动探索。
总的来说,本节课的教学过程还有待改进和完善。需要更有趣、实践性的活动和教学资源,激发学生的学习兴趣和参与度。同时,在讲解语法知识时,要注意使用简单易懂的语言,帮助学生更好地理解和掌握。通过不断改进和反思,提高教学质量,促进学生的主动学习和全面发展。
八年级英语下册课件【篇9】
《人教版八年级下册英语课件》篇章主题范文
篇章一:My Summer Vacation(我的暑假)
My summer vacation was really enjoyable. First, I visited my grandma's house in the countryside. There, I helped her plant some vegetables and played with my cousins. We rode bikes and went swimming in the nearby lake. It was a lot of fun.
After that, I went to the beach with my family. We rented a cottage and spent a week there. We swam in the ocean and built sandcastles. We also had a bonfire and made s'mores. It was a great time with my family.
Finally, I went to a summer camp with my friends. We did a lot of outdoor activities like hiking, canoeing, and zip-lining. We also had campfires and shared stories. It was a great bonding experience with my friends.
Overall, my summer vacation was a great mix of relaxation and adventure. I can't wait to do it all again next year.
篇章二:The Benefits of Exercise(运动的好处)
Exercise is important for maintaining a healthy body and mind. Firstly, it can prevent a lot of health problems such as heart disease, high blood pressure, and obesity. Regular exercise also helps improve sleep and reduces stress and anxiety. It can even help prevent depression.
Exercise also has many benefits for the brain. It can improve cognitive function, including memory and thinking skills. It increases blood flow to the brain, which is important for maintaining brain health. Exercise also helps release endorphins, which are natural mood boosters.
Finally, exercise is a great way to socialize and make new friends. Joining a sports team or fitness group is a fun way to meet people who share your interests. It's also a great way to stay motivated and accountable.
In conclusion, exercise is essential for overall health and well-being. It has many physical and mental benefits and should be included in everyone's daily routine.
八年级英语下册课件【篇10】
教案设计:
本单元的教学目标主要包括:
1. 学会本单元的生词和短语,能够进行简单的拼写和记忆。
2. 掌握本单元的语法知识,能够进行简单的句型转换。
3. 培养学生的英语听说能力,能够听懂和说出简单的英语。
教学重点和难点:
教学重点:本单元的语法知识,包括时态、语态、主谓一致等。
教学难点:培养学生的英语听说能力,包括听懂和说出简单的英语。
教学方法:
1. 听力训练:通过听录音或者播放音频,让学生掌握本单元的生词和短语,并能够进行简单的句型转换。
2. 口语训练:通过对话练习,让学生掌握本单元的语法知识,并能够进行简单的句型转换。
3. 阅读训练:通过阅读文章,让学生掌握本单元的生词和短语,并能够进行简单的句型转换。
4. 游戏教学:通过游戏的形式,让学生更好地掌握本单元的语法知识。
教学评价:
教学评价主要包括课堂表现评价、作业评价和考试成绩评价。
课堂表现评价:通过课堂上的表现,如回答问题、积极参与课堂讨论、认真听讲等,来评估学生的学习效果。
作业评价:通过作业,如填空题、选择题、对话练习等,来评估学生对本单元的掌握情况。
考试成绩评价:通过学生的考试成绩,如单元测验、期末测验等,来评估学生对本单元的掌握情况。
反思:
通过这次教学,我发现学生对于本单元的语法知识掌握情况不够好,需要加强听力和口语训练,以及提高学生的阅读水平。
八年级英语下册课件【篇11】
新教材(冀教版)八年级英语(下册)
Lesson 25 Let’s Do An Experiment!
LESSON PRERATATION
Words and phrases:
science, experiment, fill, prove, theory, jar, upside, observe, right side up, upside down.
LESSON STRUCTURE
CLASS OPENING: Greed each other.
KEY STEPS:
STEP 1: Ask the class to discuss the questions in the “Think About It”. STEP 2: Let the students listen to the tape carefully with the following question:” Why does Danny say they should do this experiment outside?” ; “ What’s Brain’s theory? ”; “ What will Brain do?”; “Does Danny have the same theory as Brain’s?”
STEP3: listen to the tape again. The student’s better read the dialogue at the same time. After reading and listening, let the students fill in the chart by themselves.
What do we need when we do the experiment?
Water, a jar, A piece of cardboard
How do we do it?(steps)
1. fill…in…;
2. cover…with…;
3. turn…upside down.
What are Brain’s and Jenny’s theories?
1. The floor gets wet.
2. The floor won’t get wet.
Reason
discuss
Step 4: after filling it, ask the students to describe the experiment. Then, write it in the exercise-book.
Step 5. read the dialogue and act it out by the students.
Step 6. homework. Be ready to give us a morning report of tomorrow.
Language Notes:
Explain some sentences and phrases.
1.I fill a jar with water.
fill…with…
On hearing the news. Her eyes filled with tears.
2.I turn the jar upside down.
upside down
That picture is upside down.
3.I think the floor will get wet.
The days gets longer in spring.
4.I’m sure that the floor won’t get wet.
Tom ia sure that he will win the game.
5.We can prove who’s right.
My theory will prove (to be) right some day.
6.We’ll do the experiment and observe what will happen.
I observed her dance.
CLASS CLOSING:
Say good-bye to the students.
[1]
YJS21.cOm更多幼儿园教案小编推荐
2025五年级英语下册课件
经过认真的整理我们为您梳理了“五年级英语下册课件”,感谢大家帮助分享这份资料让大家能够更好地学习和成长。老师职责的一部分是要弄自己的教案课件,当然教案课件里的内容一定要很完善。教案是教学效果的可视化呈现。
五年级英语下册课件 篇1
教学目标:
能听说读写单词:lady fire radio field telephone hope
1.能熟练运用这类句子”She didn’t…She worked…谈论人们过去的生活。
2.学会归纳动词的过去式,并能灵活运用。
3.教学重点:
学会归纳动词的过去式,并能灵活运用。
教学过程:
一.预习检测
英汉互译并连线。
有关中国的节目many years ago
许多年以前programme about China
谈论last night
在田野里on a fire
昨天晚上in the fields
在火上talk about
二.合作探究,学习课文。
1.听课文录音,圈出文中出现的动词过去式。
2.同桌学习课文。
3.师讲解“or”的用法.
三.巩固练习
完成课本第二部分。
练习检测
五年级英语下册课件 篇2
第三课时
教学目标:
1、听说认读掌握生词:big small long short2、能够正确书写句子:How much is it? It's ten yuan.3、理解课文对话的内容。
4、引导孩子根据自己的身高等情况购买衣服。
【教学重点】听说认读掌握生词:skirt shirt jacket dress T-shirt
【教学难点】单词拼读;书写指导
【教具准备】
1、本课生词的单词卡片
2、配套的教学课件
3、相配套的教学录音带
4、学生自己的衣物
5、课文主题图
6、大小写字母卡片
【教学过程】
(一)热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)
1、Free talk
What color do you like?
What color is your /„?
2、Let’s chant
B部分的Let’s chant.的歌谣,边说边出示单词。
(二)呈现新课(Presentation)
1、教师准备好一些大小不一的衣服。说:“I think this skirt is pretty.”然后教师穿一下,说:“But it’s too big.”然后再拿起一件,说:“This one, it’s nice.It’s fits me well.”
2、教师请一个孩子上来选衣服,指导孩子运用句子:This shirt is „,but it’s too„.3、然后多请上几个孩子上来说。
4、小组活动
孩子们把自己的衣服带来,在小组中每个孩子轮流挑选衣服,在这一过程中运用This shirt is „,but it’s too„.5、观看课件,认读句子,让孩子逐句认度,小组认读。
6、教师指读生词,让孩子抢答认读。小组比赛拼读,抽查孩子的拼读。
7、两人一小组,一个拼,一个写。单词的抄写练习。
8、出示句子的句卡,然后孩子试读,教师提示学生注意第一个单词第一个字母大写,提示孩子注意标点和占格。
(三)趣味操练(Practice)
1、拼一拼,猜一猜
教师拼一个单词,让孩子迅速说出词
孩子小组做游戏
2、听一听,拼一拼
每个小组一套字母卡片,请一个孩子说词,小组拼,比比谁最快。
3、教师请几个孩子穿上不同大小的衣服(有的服装不合适),然后大家一起来评论一下。运用句子This shirt is „,but it’s too„.(四)扩展性活动(Add-activities)
每个孩子设计一套衣服,给自己的和别人的娃娃穿上,然后进行比较。运用本单元学过的句型。
五年级英语下册课件 篇3
知识要求:
1.通过听力和阅读,结合图片猜测出文章的基本意思。结合所学知识进一步理解文章的含义。能流利的朗读课文。
2.学会句型where did you come from? I come from Liannan,Guangdong.并能用该句型做对话。
3.学习字母“o”在单词中的发音。
课标要求:P1,P2,P3。
学习重点:
通过听力和阅读,结合图片猜测出文章的基本意思。结合所学知识进一步理解文章的含义。
学习难点:
能流利的朗读课文
教学用具:
自制课件
教学过程:
一、复习
1.播放P4的单词和review部分的录音,让学生跟读。
2.用review部分的句型简单做几个对话。
二、学习·研讨
1.导入新课。
同学们:你们喜欢看马戏表演吗?今天老师就带着大家来看看马戏表演。请大家打开课文第3页。
2.学习单词circus 和句型Here comes a circus!
3.学会句型where did you come from? I come from Liannan,Guangdong.并能用该句型做对话。
4.播放课文动画两边,让学生边看动画边联系上下文理解文章的意思。
5.继续播放对话三遍,让学生跟读。
6.让学生朗读两遍。
三、操练
1、pair work(练习对话)。
2.检查效果(点名做对话)。
四、学习发音和单词
1.让学生猜测单词的意思。
2.播放录音三遍,让学生跟读。
3.讲解字母“o”在单词中的发音规律。
4.齐读后点名读。
5.播放listen and chant的录音让学生跟读,让学生说说他的意思。
五、作业
抄写p3的conversation和p8的Sounds and words.
六、板书设计
Unit One Where were you last month?
Where did you come from?
I come from Liannan,Guangdong. Here comes a circus!
五年级英语下册课件 篇4
一、教材分析:
这是孩子们学习英语的第三年,二级目标的第二个学期。与其他教材一样有扉页、人物介绍等内容。话题分别是“外貌特征”“ 课程和周末活动”“食物与饮料”“家务活”“房间与家具”“自然界”。本册书的内容与目标记录如下:
1、能听、说、读、写 68 个短语和单词以及 12 组句子和 4 个单 句(包括日常活动、季节、学校日历、复活节、物品归属和正在做 的事情等几个话题) 。要求能在真实语境中正确运用并能读懂简短语篇。
2、能听、说、认读 87 个单词。
3、能听懂、会唱 6 首歌曲。
4、能听懂、会吟唱 6 首歌谣。
5、能完成 8 个自我评价活动。
6、能理解 6 个幽默小故事。
7、能了解 6 项简单的中西方文化生活知识。
8、能听懂,理解 6 个谚语。
二、学情分析:
五年级学生已学过两年多的英语,已有一定的语言基础,良好的听、说、读、写英语的习惯已基本养成。但由于教材难度逐渐加大,少数学生由于遇到困难,学习兴趣会随之减弱,两极分化逐渐比较严重。教师应以学生的发展为宗旨,把激发学生的学习兴趣放在首位,引导学生端正学习态度,掌握良好的学习方法,培养学生良好的学习习惯。在开学起始阶段,教师带领学生对即将学习的教材采用“巡游”的方式,将本学期的评价、习惯规范、学习内容和目标进行讲解和说明,有助于学生保持英语学习兴趣、提高学生英语学习效率。
三、教学目标
1.学生知道本学期的评价方式和基本要求。
2.学生初步了解本册书的学习内容。
3.学生明白自己在本学期的英语学习中该做哪些准备。
4.学生放松心态,更好地投入英语学习。
四、教具准备:英语书、教学课件、评价表格
五、教学流程:
(一) 自由交流,热身导入→师生谈话,引入教材巡游→情境创设,树立目标(学生每人两句话,写在英语书的扉页上)
(二) 教材巡游的步骤:
1.阅读教材的“说明”部分,交流阅读后的收获。
2.学生阅读教材的“前言”部分,思考:本部分告诉我们哪些?你对那几句感兴趣?你对“阅读”的理解是什么?这一部分提到了哪些学习方法?
3.看教材的目录,请学生试着读一读,看能读懂哪些?
4.解教材中的人物。
5.看课后的“单元词汇表”和“词汇表”理解标志符号的含义。
(三) 新学期开始了,你打算有哪些提高呢?请把你本学期想做的事情写在英语书的扉页上,最多写三条,期末要进行评价啊。
(四)教师提本学期的要求:根据自己的情况确定。
六、教学过程:(35分钟)
(一) 听、唱英语歌曲,导入英语环境中。(3分钟)
Let’s sing a song: The Hokey Pokey
(二)Free talk (5分钟)
What’s the weather like today?
How many new things do you have? What are they?
(三)师生谈话,教材巡游(22分钟)
1.学生翻阅教材,谈教材的组成。(1分钟)
T: 我们的教材由哪些部分组成?
扉页,说明,前言,contents, 人物,单元内容,单元词汇表,词汇表
2.学生阅读说明部分,获取信息。(2分钟)
读中你了解到哪些信息?
3. 学生阅读“前言“部分,思考一下问题,试着用笔标注。(3分钟)
(1)本部分告诉我们哪些?
(2)你对哪几句感兴趣?
(3)你对“阅读“的理解是什么?
(4)这一部分提到了哪些学习方法?
4.看教材目录,了解本册教材话题内容。(10分钟)
(1)学生试着读出每单元的题目,并猜测一下该单元要学习哪些内容?之前学过与之相关的单词和对话有哪些?
5. 观看人物页面,了解本册书中的人物。(1分钟)
6. 看课后的“单元词汇表”和 “词汇表”的理解标志符号的含义。(3分钟)
了解本学期每单元四会、三会单词的数量,试着读一读自己会读多少单词。
四)教师讲解本学期的常规要求。(2分钟)
(教师可以结合自己的日常要求进行补充,)
1. 每天听录音15分钟。
2.上课认真听讲,眼睛看老师。
3.作业按时完成,按时上交。
4.教师的电话。
前三条是每位学生应该做到的,留下教师电话是方便学生和家长随时咨询。
(五)学生在扉页上写出自己本学期的目标,随时督促、激励自己。(1分钟)
(六)教师给学生一些英语学习的建议。(2分钟)
your lessons well before every class. (预习)
what you’ve learned in time.(复习)
more and read different materials.(多读)
as often as possible. (多写)
more either in class or out of class.(多说)
to your teachers for advice and help. (多问)
五年级英语下册课件 篇5
一、教学内容:
unit 1 b: look, read and learn c: ask and answer
二、教学目标:
1、学生能听得懂、会说、会读和会拼写单词:a student, a teacher, a doctor, a nurse.
2、学生能听得懂、会说、会读和会写句型:who’s that boy / girl / man / woman? he’s / she’s… he’s / she’s a…
3、学生能听懂、会说、会读日常交际用语:welcome back to school.
4、初步熟悉歌曲:who’s that boy?
5、通过“认人”的语言学习,培养学生实际运用英语进行交流的能力和乐于于人交流、合作的个性。
三、教学重点:
会单词和句型:
听、说、读、写. 四、教学难点:能正确的使用 ”he” 与 ”she”.
四、教学准备:
1、人物职业图和yang ling等人物图片。
2、准备学生照片两张,老师照片一张,每个学生准备自己家庭成员的照片若干。
3、录音机、磁带。
五、教学过程:
Step 1. free talk
1、以good morning / afternoon, boys and girls. how are you? / how are you this morning / afternoon / today? nice to see you! / glad to see you! are you happy today? / how old are you? 等和学生招呼,学生依照情形回答。
2、在与每位学生问候结束时,送上一句 welcome back to school.
Step 2. presentation and practice
1、good morning, boys and girls . nice to see you! welcome back to school. 出示 welcome back to school. 理解并领读。
2、good morning, my dear friends. i’m so happy to meet you all. but where are our old friends yang ling、david、su yang、su hai and helen. let’s go and meet them. 出示yang ling等人物的图片,故意把图片缩的很小或故意遮住一部分或者出示人物的侧面图。 t: who’s that boy / girl / man / woman? s: he’s / she’s…
3、point to the students do ask and answer. t: who’s that boy / girl? s: he’s / she’s…
4、let students do ask and answer in pairs then check several pairs.
5、sing a song: who’s that girl? (先让学生静听歌曲,然后让他们跟唱)
6、出示改装过的,戴着眼镜穿着医生服饰的mr brown的图。 t:who’s that man? s:sorry, i don’t know. t:(出示未经过改装的mr brown 的图) he’s mr brown. he’s a doctor.(学习新单词:doctor)
7、借助mrs brown 的图,教学单词:nurse (同上)
8、出示一位学生的照片: t: who’s that boy / girl? s: he’s / she’s … t: (补充说明) yes, and he’s / she’s a student.(学习新单词:student)
9、出示学生熟悉的一位老师的照片: t: who’s that man / woman? s: he’s / she’s… t: (补充说明) and he’s / she’s a teacher. (学习新单词:teacher)
Step 3. look, read, say and write
1、show the new words in part b, let students read after the tape.
2、出示职业特征不是很明显的人物图片。 eg: t: is he a doctor? s: no, i think he’s a nurse.
五年级英语下册课件 篇6
一、教学目标
1、能够听、说、读、写动词短语的ing 形式:drawing pictures , doing the dishes , cooking dinner , reading a book , answering the phone。
2、能运用句子“What are you doing ? I am doing the dishes/„”询问别人正在做什么 并作答。
3、通过说唱Let’s chant 部分的歌谣巩固复习Let’s learn 部分的动词短语和句子。
4、学唱歌曲“What are you doing ?”。
二、教学重、难点
1、本课时的重点是掌握五个动词短语的ing 形式,能够理解下一课时的主要句型:
What are you doing 并能够用I am doing the dishes/„作答。
2、难点是:动词短语ing 形式的读音。
三、课前准备
教师准备各种动词短语卡片、图片等。准备锅、铲、电话、碗碟等小道具。准
备实物投影仪、录音机及录音带。
四、教学步骤
1、热身
(1)教师放歌曲“What are you doing ”的录音。
(2)日常口语练习。
2、预习
教师出示一个动作短语卡片,如: do the dishes 说I can do the dishes,引导学生
说Me too,然后教师用其他的动词短语卡片进行替换,带领学生继续操练。,3、新课呈现
Let’s lean
(1)教师再次拿出do the dishes 的卡片,同时在黑板上写下do the dishes,教师边做洗 碗的动作,边对学生说: I am doing the dishes.然后在黑板上的短语后面加上ing 变成 doing the dishes.教师引导学生做洗碗的动作,并跟说:Me too.然后继续用其他的卡 片进行替换,通过适当的动作引导学生理解现在进行时表达的含义.(2)出示动作卡片,通过让学生说动作短语,并将动作短语转换成ing 的形式.(3)给学生提供调色盘、电话、碗碟等小道具,教师问:What are you doing ?引导
学生边做动作边回答:I am drawing pictures/doing the dishes/cooking dinner/answering the phone/reading a book
(4)让学生听录音,跟读Let’s learn 部分的词汇,要求学生边听边指,力求做到“眼 到、手到、口到、心到”。
(5)教师把本部分的五张动词卡片面朝上贴在黑板、窗户、门、墙等上面,然后说
一张卡片上的短语,如: drawing pictures , 学生迅速指向该图片,指得又快又准确的 学生为胜者。
(6)教师依次出示本部分的五张短语ing 形式的卡片并提问:What are you doing?,学生做出相应的动作并回答:I am„。
Let’s chant
教师播放该部分的录音,让学生听录音跟读两遍后试着分组说唱歌谣。
--1--
五年级英语下册课件 篇7
知识目标:
1.能够听、说、读、写以下动词短语:eat breafast, d rning exercises, have…class, pla sprts, eat dinner.
2.能够听懂问句:When d u d rning exercises / …? 并能用所学动词短语替换句型“At …”中的关键词回答问句。
能力目标:能理解并跟唱Let’s sing的歌谣。
情感目标:能够合理安排日常学习和周末活动。
教学重点:掌握A部分Let’s learn中的五个动词短语,并能用这五个短语回答询问作息时间的问题。
教学难点:掌握五个四会短语和单词exercises的正确发音。
教学准备:、单词图片
教学过程:
Preparatin—准备活动
1.Let’s sing《Ten candles》,听并跟唱三年级上册第六单元歌曲复习数字,为本节课时间表达做铺垫。
2.Free tal:复习上节课重点内容。
S1:When d u get up?
S2:I get up at 5 ’clc.
S1: When d u…?
S2: I… at…’clc.
Presentatin—新知呈现
1.由Free tal环节自然引入Prdr的时间安排,T:H5
五年级英语下册课件 篇8
PEP五年级下册第四单元第一课时教案
Unit 4 What are you doing?第一课时 一Teaching contents A Let’s learn Let’s play C Let’s sing 二learning objectives a) will be able to listen ,read and speak and write the following phrases: drawing pictures, cooking dinner, doing the dishes, reading a book, answering the phone. b) 能够领悟动词后面加上ing 的内在涵义 c) 通过说唱Let’s sing部分的歌谣巩固短语和句子。 三 Important and difficult point Important point:掌握五个四会动词短语的ing形式。 Difficult point: 动词词组ing形式的读音及拼写。 四Teaching aids 1)教师准备词卡,和录音机,磁带 2)教师准备ppt 五:Teaching process 一)Warm-up/revision 1. Daily communication. 2. let’s chant Do, do, do the dishes. Read, read, read a book. Draw, draw, draw pictures. Cook, cook, cook dinner. Answer, answer, answer the phone 3课件出示 1) What do you do on the weekend? I often ……. (go shopping, play the piano, read a book, do the dishes, cook dinner…) 2) What can you do? I can ………………(教师用动作示意) (sweep the floor cook dinner wash the clothes wash the window draw pictures empty the trash……) 二) presentation/practice (当学生说到draw pictures……) 1) drawing pictures 1. T:I can draw pictures too. And I am drawing pictures now. (操练(个人朗读,小组朗读………,板书) 2. 操练 I am drawing a duck. I am drawing a banana. I am drawing ___. 2)cooking dinner 课件出示一只猪 T:What’s this? Ss: It’s a pig. T: Yes, it’s a helpful pig. She can do many things. She can sweep the floor, she can cook the meals, wash the clothes….But what’s she doing now. Let’s ask him: Pig ,pig, what are you doing? Pig:I am cooking dinner. 3)Let’s sing What are you doing? What are you doing? I am drawing pictures. I am drawing pictures. What are you doing? What are you doing? I am cooking. I am cooking. 4)课件出示一只累了 的`猪 T:What’s happened to Miss pig? S: She is tired. T:Yes, because she has been cooking for two hours. She is very tired .She wants to play with others. So she calls Mr sheep. 5) doing the dishes Pig: Sheep, sheep, what are you doing? Can you play with me? Sheep: sorry. I can’t. I am doing the dishes.(板书,操练) 6) Pair work(就sheep和pig 之间对话) 6)reading a book T: Mr sheep is busy. He is doing the dishes. So pig calls Mr dog. Pig:Dog ,dog, what are you doing? Dog: I am reading a book.(板书,低高音朗读) 7)I am reading an English book. I am reading a Chinese book. I am reading a/an ___. 8)answering the phone. T: Mr dog is busy ,too. At last, she calls Miss cat. Pig:Cat, cat, what are you doing? Cat: I am answering the phone. Pig: oh, oh, can you play with me? Cat: OK! Let’s go. 9) 同桌之间操练 10)Read all the words 11) Let’s chant What are you doing? What are you doing? I’m doing the dishes. What are you doing? I’m drawing pictures. What are you doing? I’m reading a book. What are you doing? I’m cooking dinner. What are you doing? I’m answering the phone. 11) open the book, then read after the tape. 12) Play a game 做一做(一名学生上台做动作) 问一问(其他学生问) A: What are you dong? 答一答(这名学生回答) B:I am……… 13) Look and say I often…. I am …. cook dinner cooking dinner eat dinner eating dinner ………….. 14)总结规律 15)read and write Wu: What are you doing, John? John: I am … Wu: Thank you. What are you doing ,father? Father: I am… Wu: Hi, bear.What are you doing? Bear: I am …. Wu: Mom.What are you doing? Mom: I am… Wu: Thank you. What are you doing, uncle? Uncle: I am… 16) Design about your day. (来设计你的一天) My Day eg: I am ___________at _____ 三)Homework 1.完成相应的作业本和抄写本上的练习。 2 课间用今天所学的句子进行对话操练 3 背诵今天的单词,并默三次,中文 一 次。 六blackboard design What are you doing? I am answering the phone. drawing pictures cooking dinner doing the dishes reading a book五年级英语下册课件 篇9
五年级第一周第一课时教案
教学目标:寒假作业讲评 教学重点:寒假作业中的知识点 教学难点:寒假作业中的知识点 教学目标:知识目标:上册知识巩固检查 过程方法:教师提问的`方式进行 情感态度:培养学生认真完成作业的态度 教学过程: warming up: greeting: Good morning class! Good morning ,Miss Ma! How are you today? Im fine ,thank you.And you? Im fine,thank you. Now please say something about your winter holiday. 学生互相用英语谈论寒假的经历。 作业讲评:1.表扬作业做得好的 2.作业做得不好的也给一定的警示 提问:1.上册单词提问 2.上册句型及关键句用法提问 3.假期做的练习题 4.物主单词和人称单词的用法提问 提出需要注意的问题:1.书写认真 2.基础知识掌握要牢固 3.多读多练,每天坚持听15-20分钟录音。 4.对知识点要牢记五年级英语下册课件 篇10
人教PEP五年级下册英语
Unit 1 This is my day
第三课时
一、教学目标:
掌握四会句子:When do you eat dinner? I eat dinner at 7:00 in the evening.When do you get up?I usually get up at 12:00 at noon.二、教学重难点:
1、单词policeman:分音节朗读police—man,重点处理police的读音;
2、句子Thank you for telling me about your day.的意思:启发学生自己说出;朗读时要注意意群的处理。
三、教学准备:
1、录音:Read and write部分;Pronunciation部分。
2、教师准备一顶警帽。
3、四会句子中的单词卡片若干套。
四、教学过程:
1、Warm –up(热身)
活动一双簧表演
教学参考时间:3-4分钟
学生两人一组表演双簧,一人做动作,另一人躲在他/她背后说句子,如:―I get up at 6:30.‖
(先两人一组练1分钟,再进行汇报,学生评出最佳组合。)
活动二自由调查
教学参考时间:3分钟
教师指导学生展开自由调查,可允许学生离开座位,自由询问其他同学的作息时间安排,然后填充Make a survey部分表格。在活动中可讨论如何更合理地安排作息时间。
2、Presentation(新课呈现)
活动三判断句子
教学参考时间:2分钟
(1)教师出示句子:
a、I get up at 6:30 in the morning.b、I get up at 12:00 at noon.I go to work at 7:20 in the morning.I go to work at 9:00 in the evening.I play sports at 3:30 in the afternoon.I play sports at 3:00 in the afternoon.I go to bed at 10:00 in the evening.I go to bed at 7:00 in the morning.(2)请学生朗读后判断,哪组句子的作息时间更符合我们的生活实际。
(3)教师说:Yes, Part A is my timetable.(指着相应的句子)I don’t go to bed at 7:00 in the morning.But some people really go to bed at 7:00 in the morning.Who are they?
活动四学习对话
教学参考时间:8分钟
(1)教师出示教材P6左上插图,对图提问:What do you do?点击对话中的句子:I am a policeman.带领学生学习单词policeman,着重强调police得发音。教师说:下面阅读对话,了解一下他的作息时间。
(2)学生自己阅读对话,初步了解对话的意思。
(3)教师出示六幅插图,启发同学找出对话中说明这六幅图的语句。其中四幅为教材P6对话周围的插图。
A、(内容为警察起床):When do you get up?I usually get up at 12:00 at noon.B、左上:When do you go to work?I go to work at 9:00 in the evening.C、(内容警察下班回家):I go home at 5:00 in the morning.D、左下: I eat breakfast at 6:00.Then I go to bed.E、右下:When do you eat dinner?I eat dinner at 7:00 in the evening.F、右上:And I play sports at about 3:00 in the afternoon.(4)播放对话录音,学生跟读对话。
出示句子:Can I ask you some questions?Thank you for telling me about your day.点击发音,学生再次跟读,并说出意思。引导学生认识警察工作的艰辛,从而尊重他们的职业。
(5)Finish his timetable:教师出示(3)中的插图和句子给与提示。
学生独立完成,教师巡视辅导,检查。
活动五抄写句子
教学参考时间:3分钟
请学生在作业本上抄写句子:
When do you eat dinner? I eat dinner at 7:00 in the evening.When do you get up?I usually get up at 12:00at noon.3、Let’s play(趣味操练)
活动六拼组句子
教学参考时间:3分钟
学生2-3人一组,教师为每组发一套句子的单词卡片,开始以组为单位拼句子;拼完自己的句子后,下座位在其他组所拼的句子中找到相应的问题或答语,看哪些组配合的最默契。
4、Consolidation and extension(巩固与扩展)
活动七语音练习
教学参考时间:10分钟
(1)教师出示单词:waitrainpainttrain,学生跟录音大声朗读;
引导学生总结出ai在这些词中的发音 [ei];
出示单词:rainbowmailsailtailwailagain学生自己试着拼读。
(2)教师出示单词:sayplaytodaymay,学生跟录音大声朗读;
引导学生总结出ay在这些词中的发音 [ei];
出示单词:dayawayalwaysstaypay学生自己试着拼读。
(3)教师出示单词:greatgreengrowgrass,学生跟录音大声朗读;引导学生总结出gr在这些词中的发音 [gr];
出示单词:grandmagrandpagrapes greygreetgroundgroup 学生自己试着拼读。
(4)教师出示单词:gladglueglassglove,学生跟录音大声朗读;引导学生总结出gl在这些词中的发音 [gl];
出示单词:gladlyglowgloomglobegloss学生自己试着拼读。
(5)出示教材p11三组绕口令,学生两人一组拼读带有红色字母的单词,再结合插图说说它们的意思。
(6)教师播放录音,学生跟读。
活动八练一练
教学参考时间:5分钟
(1)活动手册P3—5
学生独立阅读短文,画出表示作息时间的句子;
完成下面练习
(答案)I go to work at 6:30 in the evening.When do you eat dinner?
I usually go home at 8:00 in the morning.When do you play sports?
(2)活动手册P3—6可以在课下完成。
活动九小结
教学参考时间:3-4分钟
(1)、全班一起朗读Read and write部分对话。
(2)、借助Timetable以第一人称的形式叙述这名警察的作息时间。
五、板书 UnitOneThisIsMyDay(3)
When do you eat dinner? I eat dinner at 7:00 in the evening.When do you get up?I usually get up at 12:00at noon.Time table
Go to work9:00 p.m.Go home5:00 a.m.Get up12:00a.m.Play sports3:00 p.m.
五年级英语下册课件 篇11
一、教学内容
本课是PEP五年级下学期中的Unit3My birthday第1课时的教学内容。本单元的核心教学内容是月份,通过生日,为学生操练对话创设了一个真实的语言情景,贴近学生的生活和学习实际,有利于学生对语言的学习、吸收和运用。此外,这部分还重点介绍了When is your birthday? My birthday is in----句型。这一单元和上一单元的季节有内在的联系,要懂得划分,并可以互相提问。
二、学生分析
本课面向的是已有一定英语基础的五年级学生,他们已经具备了初步的听、说、读、写能力,尤其是听、说、读的能力,经过近两年的学习,明显领先于写的能力。另外他们还具备了一定的计算机操作能力。因此,他们完全有能力在教师引导下自主性学习。同时,本单元的教学内容与学生的实际生活息息相关,因此本课时的教学内容对学生来说不难理解,关键是句型的学习和在日常生活中的应用。
三、设计思路
的要求,强调要激发学生对英语学习的兴趣,让学生主动有效地参与学习过程。为拓展教学内容,将学生兴趣得以激发,我把教材转化成动画教学,将枯燥的教学兴趣化,将生硬的教学情景化,通过flash动画教学,以体验式教学形式来引发学生的探究热情。我主要是按照“任务型教学”的结构来设计课堂活动的,运用多媒体课件进行教学。由于所设计的一系列活动始终围绕月份的学习,并且可以对伟人的诞辰进行学习,教育学生要时时缅怀伟人。
四、教学内容和目标:
1.知识:能听、说、读12个月份的名称并能书写其缩写形式。
words: January, February, March, April, May ,June, July, August, September, October, November, December.
Sentences: When is your birthday ? My birthday is in----.
2.能力:
通过各种活动的参与、实践、体验等过程,提高学生的语言能力和学习能力,让学生得到自我发展和个性发展。提高和培养学生听、说、读和对话交际能力,交往能力和实践能力,以及培养学生通过网络进行自主学习的能力。
3.情感:
查找名人的生日,以大量的课外知识来丰富和愉悦英语课堂教学,也丰富了学生文化知识,拓展了学生的视野。
五、教学重点与难点:
1、三会词汇:January, February, March, April, May ,June, July, August, September, October, November, December.及掌握他们的缩写形式。
2、能运用句型When is your birthday ? My birthday is in----对实际情景进行问答。
3、难点是January, February的发音和正确书写12个月份的简写形式。
六、教学用具:
1.Powerpoint;
2.Flash短片
七、教学过程
Step1.Warm up
1.Play an English song.
Question:Do you like English song? Do you like English song?
Now let’s listen to the English song : Autumn.
(设计意图:通过歌曲吸引孩子的注意力,既为进行教学服务,也增添了教与学的乐趣。在这里,英语学科和音乐,信息技术得到了很好的整合。同时也为复习四季做铺垫。)
2.Review:
(1)1.How many seasons are there in a year? What are they?
(2)How many months are there in a year? What are they?
(3)How many months are there in each season? What are they?
(You can speak in Chinese.)
(设计意图:师生间的英语交流是真实的语言环境,同时也建立起融洽、民主的师生交流渠道。由学生熟悉的季节,引出学习新词汇,做到由简入深,由旧带新。)
Step 2.Presentation
1.由How many months are there in each season? What are they?引出12个月份的教学。
(设计意图:通过问题,使学生对要学的词汇有所了解,借助多媒体课件,进行系统学习,发挥学生学习的主动性。)注意对十二个月单词缩写的强调。尤其是September(Sept.)及五、六、七月通常不缩写。
2.播放关于12 months的视频。
(设计意图:通过视频教学给同学们直观生动的形象,反复练习12个月的读法,英汉结合的方式适合同学们的过渡学习。)
Step3.Practice
1.做“各就各位”的游戏。老师将十二个月的单词依次分别做成由每个字母一张的单词卡片,并且将字母顺序打乱,分发到不同同学的手里,同学们自己找顺序将它们排列成一个完整的`单词。
(设计意图:培养同学们动手操作的能力,让他们亲身参与、亲自体验。)
2.做“小小翻译家”的游戏。老师根据flash短片随机指一个月份,同学们举手回答说出这个月份的英文名称并且拼写。
(设计意图:考验学生的反应能力并且及时反馈同学们对本节所学单词的掌握情况。)
3.继续做“小小翻译家”的游戏老师根据flash短片随机指一个月份,同学们举手回答说出这个月份的中文意思。
(设计意图:反馈学生的单词掌握情况,同时同学们对每个月份各有多少天进行初步了解,加深对课程的知识拓展,给教学增添形象性。)
Sstep4.Presentation.
1.由图片小猪的生日导入Happy birthday歌曲
(设计意图:通过歌曲吸引孩子的注意力,既为进行教学服务,也增添了教与学的乐趣。在这里,英语学科和音乐,信息技术得到了很好的整合。)
2.讲解Target Language
When is your birthday? My birthday is in ….一个学生回答之后,再邀请其他学生问答。注意:每个月分的首字母要大写。
(设计意图:反复的句型操练,有助于同学们巩固所学生词。)
3.Pair work.
A: When is your birthday?
B: My birthday is in…….
(设计意图:让学生有效地进行双边对话练习,印象更深刻。)
nsolidation
为即将生日的同学制作一张邮卡。
(设计意图:给同学们足够的空间,自己动手查找,寻找成功的途径,体验成功的快乐。)
2025三年级英语下册课件
俗话说,做什么事都要有计划和准备。作为幼儿园的老师,我们都希望小朋友们能在课堂上学到知识,最好的解决办法就是准备好教案来加强学习效率,。提前准备好教案可以有效的提高课堂的教学效率。那么一篇好的幼儿园教案要怎么才能写好呢?由此,小编为你收集并整理了2025三年级英语下册课件仅供参考,欢迎大家阅读。
三年级英语下册课件 篇1
教学目标(Objectives):
1.确保学生认识和理解一些基本单词的意义和简单口头运用(To learn the meaning and simple usages of some words and phrases)。
需要掌握的词组:Tomorrow Woman
2.学习使用本单元重点句型及表达(To use the typical sentences to express)。
需要掌握的句型:
Can you play ping-pong with me?
I‘m sorry, I can’t.
Yes, let‘s go!
3.鼓励学生大胆发言及表达(To encourage the students to express bravely)。
4.培养学生对英语学科的兴趣(To make the students interest in English learning)。
5.增强学生听说读写译的能力(To strengthen t he ability of listening, speaking, reading, writing and translating)。
教学重点(Key Points):
在学习了单词的基础上,以单词为载体,进行主要句型的学习,并了解其中的语法现象,根据具体情境,学会交流对话,侧重句型语法学习,交际意向和课外拓展为重点。
教学方法:
游戏,音频,情景教学法,Pair-work两人小组活动,Group-work小组活动,多媒体辅助教学。
教学难点:
学生处于小学阶段,对英语有了初步了解 ,词汇储备较少,对于三年级下学期学生的要求重点是在会读会说的基础上,能掌握一 些基本单词的拼写和造句,了解一定的语法 内涵,与人进行简单沟通交流。
教学准备:
课件、照片素材、音频文件、 教学道具。教学设计:
Step1. Greeting
Step2. Warm-up/Leading(热身/课程导入)
Warm-up Question
1)你如何邀请别人和你一起玩耍?
2)Survey:
Can you play ping-pong with me?
I’m sorry, I can‘t.
Yes, let’s go!
Step3.Present ation(呈现新课)
1.Words Learning!
1)老师放映课件,用中文询问同学看到了什么?同学们会看到课件上呈现的图画。
2)教师拿出单词卡片,进入重点新词汇学习环节,向同学展示图片,结合PPT上放映的内容,带领同学学习一些新单词。
2. Pronunciation Part!
1)老师介绍本单元重点单词读音及重点音标 ,带领同学大声朗读。
2)然后老师带领同学进行拓展学习,介绍一些该音标构成的其他单词 。
3. Vocabulary Part!
Tomorrow
Woman
...
4. Listening Part!
请听对话材 料,完成书中所附听力练习!
Listen to the interview and complete Steve‘s schedule.
Listen to the interview again. Circle the letters on the survey.5. Reading Part!
教师立足于课本,引导学生课本上的短篇课文。
教师向同学解释对话内容,并让学生反复听读,学习模仿。
Listen to the tape, and read aloud these sentences!
Step4.小结(Summary)
学生自我 总结今天上课所学内容。
Step5.Homework!
请课后认真复习本单元语法内容,并朗诵课文对话!
Homework:
1.抄写单词十遍。
2.熟悉本课的语法知识。
3.分角色朗读课文。
4.了解本课的情景语境,学会运用新句子造句。
5.将新学习的语法或句型知 识跟班级同学相互练习,加强巩固记忆。
6.父母监督孩子家庭作业的完成。
三年级英语下册课件 篇2
教学目标
激发学生学习英语的热情,培养学生用英语思维和交流的习惯;培养学生自主学习、乐于与他人及小组合作学习的品质。
教学重难点
【教学重点】
句型How many…can you see? I can see…的初步运用;
教学工具
课件
教学过程
Step1热身/复习(Warming up/Revision)
设计意图:通过chant复习字母Aa-Ii及其在单词中的发音,激发兴趣,以旧带新。
Step2趣味操练 (Consolidation)
1.练习How many…can you see? I can see…
1) Ask and answer practice:
(让学生体会名词复数/ts/的发音和数字13-15的拼写和读音规律teen/ti:n/。)
设计意图:紧密联系学生实际,为学生提供语言环境,鼓励孩子灵活运用所学知识进行对话,培养学生敢说,爱说的习惯,力求最终培养学生语言运用的能力。
T: How many rabbits/cats/elephants can you see?
S1: I can see thirteen.
T: Rabbits, cats, elephants, /ts/ /ts/ /ts/
T: Pair work. Now please ask and answer: How many…can you see? I can see…
(学生用教室内实物进行问答练习。)
简析:此活动既练习了发音,又操练了句型,还迁移了知识。
2) Chant:
设计意图:巩固主要句型,让学生自己去发现、探究规律。
How many, how many,How many rabbits can you see?
Thirteen,thirteen,I can see thirteen.
Thirteen rabbits I can see.
(老师说出以上chant后,让学生用cats, elephants作替换自编chant。)
简析:chant替换引导学生发现构词特点,培养了学生发现规律,寻找学习、记忆方法的能力。
2.数字游戏
设计意图:抢答算式,消除疲劳,活跃气氛,培养学生的竞争意识和快速思维的能力。
T:Line up! Count from 1 to 15. Play a game: (?) +(?) =15
(老师说一个数,学生抢答另一个数字相加得20。看哪个组抢答又对又快。)
简析:教师与学生、学生与学生之间自然融洽的交流,既练习了数字的发音,增大了学生的语言输出量,扩大了学生的发言面,又使学生之间产生互动,增进了学生之间的感情,起到了很好的教学效果。
Step4拓展性活动(Expansion)
设计意图:为学生创设自主学习、亲身实践、合作交流的良好氛围,使学生有更多的机会和更强烈的愿望与他人讨论和交流。鼓励学生运用已学的语言,积极参与语言实践活动。在活动中开拓思维,积极体验,从而提高语言的运用能力。
T:Choose one picture to talk about in your group. Try to use the sentence patterns: How many… can you see? I can see… 5 minutes for you.
(课件出现Park和Farm场景,小组内自选场景进行交流。)
E.g.: Group one’s dialogue:
S1: Today is sunny. Let’s go to the supermarket. OK?
S23: OK!
S4: No, I’m going to the park.
S5: Me, too.
S123: See you.
S1: So many beautiful flowers. How many flowers can you see?
S2: One, two, three. I can see three.
S1: How many people can you see?
S3: One, two, three, four, five, six, seven, eight, nine, ten, eleven. I can see eleven.
S1: Yes, what are they doing?
S23: They are rowing a boat.
S1: How many boats?
S23: One, two, three, four, five. We can see five.
S1: Let’s fly the kites, OK?
S23: OK!
S1: How many kites can you see?
S23: One, two, three……twelve.
S1: No, ten. The black two are birds.
S1: Time is up. We are going to go home.
S23: OK!
(找两组同学上台展示,一组表演in the park,一组表演On the happy farm。
简析:课堂上创设生活中的'情境,让学生扮演自己喜爱的角色,来体会成功的喜悦,感受英语口语的魅力,既培养了学生的语感,又激发了学生学英语的兴趣,有利于学生将所学语言运用到实际生活中来。
Step5结尾(Ending)
1. Song: One two three four five
设计意图:音乐是最能直接感动人的艺术,喜欢听唱歌曲是孩子们的天性。
T:You behaved very well. Now a beautiful song for you.
Ss: One two three four five. Once I caught a fish alive. Six seven eight nine ten. Then I let it go again.
T: Why did you let it go?
Ss: Cause it bit my finger so.
T: Which finger did it bite?
Ss: This little finger on the right.
简析:通过师生对唱、男女对唱既复习了单词、句型,又活跃了课堂,在欢快的氛围中结束学习。
2. 小结(Sum up)
课后小结
学了这节课,你有什么收获?
课后习题
完成课后练习题。
板书
How many
三年级英语下册课件 篇3
源莲
山课件 w Y K M
课题
Unit 1 Welcome back to school!课型 新授课 课时 A-1 教 学 目
标 知识与技能:能听说单词Welcome,back,boy,and,girl,we,new, friend,today,from等;会运用句子I’m /I’m from介绍自己及自己的情况。过程与方法:创设情景,小组合作学习中巩固运用句型和单词。情感、态度和价值观:培养学生尊重他人的良好品质。重点
难点 理解单词boy,girl,friend。
和from的读音不易掌握。2.认识和理解英语中人名、地名及国家名称的写法和读法。学法
指导 学生活动 教具 学具 单词卡片 通案 个案
一、热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)
师生问候,用英语打招呼 Welcome back to school!复习巩固学过的内容,创设英语学习氛围。
二、新课展示(Presentation)
1.教师借助Amy和 Zhang Peng的头饰向学生介绍引出单词:boy,girl,friend。2.利用单词卡片教学生认读单词:boys and girls, today, new friends。
3.教师带头饰自我介绍:Hi,I’m ’m from the UK.借助国旗引导学生认识英国的英语名称。
4.教师带头饰自我介绍:Hi,I’m Zhang ’m from Shandong.借助国旗引导学生认识英国、美国和加拿大的英语名称。
5.教师点拨:英语中人名、地名和国家名称的首写字母大写的写法。the UK是英文缩写形式必须都大写,读作U和K。(6)听课文录音,跟读对话。
三、趣味操练(Practice)1.学生两人一组分角色练习对话。2.小组展示:表演对话。
and say:看国旗,编对话运用句子:I’m /I’m from介绍自己及自己的情况。理解What about you?的含义。
四、作业(Homework)
仿照课文对话,自己创编对话并表演。
课 堂 检
测
一、看图连线。
boy
friend
girl
一、选择。
_____ am _____ the ____ two new friends 4.介绍自己来自美国时,应说:’m from the ’m the 介绍自己时应说:’m is Amy.课题
Unit 1 Welcome back to school!课型 新授课 课时 A-2 教 学 目
标 知识与技能:能听说认读单词:UK,Canada,USA,China.主要通过情景对话学习介绍自己的国籍,并在实际情景中自然运用。
过程与方法:借助国家的国旗和标志性建筑图片,帮助学生理解和认读国家名称。情感、态度和价值观:培养学生乐于模仿,敢于交流。重点
难点 国家名称的读音。掌握Canada的单词正确读音。学法
指导 学生活动 教具 学具 图片和单词卡片 通案 个案
一、热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)’s sing!2.日常口语练习
I’m ….I’m from Wu’an.二、新课展示(Presentation)
1.老师出示国旗图片,让学生认识,引出单词:UK,USA,China,Canada。2.认读单词。
3.听录音或看课件认识不同国家的标志性建筑物,并跟读单词。4.学生小组讨论:这些图片中的建筑物名称及所属国家。5.小组活动:把图片和国家配对。看看谁最先完成。
教师出示事先准备好的国家国旗和建筑物的图片等,一个人出示图片,另一个人说:I’m from….让学生反复练习句子。6.听录音,跟读对话。
三、趣味操练(Practice)
1.两人一组用国旗或图片进行对话。’s chant。听录音,跟着说唱。
四、作业(Homework)听课文录音,熟记单词和图片。
课 堂 检
测
一、把图片和所属国家连线。
USA
China
Canada
UK
二、对话连线: Nice to see to meet is my friend, to see you.课题 Unit 1 Welcome back to school!课型 新授课 课时 A-3 教 学 目
标 知识与技能:学习元音字母a在单词中的发音以及认读书写含有这个字母的单词。过程与方法:借助手势教学字母发音,归类识记单词。情感、态度和价值观:培养学生良好的学习习惯。重点
难点 掌握元音字母a的发音和单词的书写。
元音a的发音,引导学生认识字母有元音和辅音之分。学法
指导 学生活动 教具 学具 字母卡 单词卡 通案 个案
一、热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)1.日常口语练习。
2.复习上册书的有关字母A的Let’s chant!
二、新课展示(Presentation)
1.教师出示字母卡并问:What’s it? An“ Aa”.What’s the sound of letter “A”?引导学生说出元音字母a在单词中的发音/?/。2.出示含有这个字母相同发音的单词图片。cat bag hand dad /?/ 3.放Let’s spell部分的录音,学生跟读。
4.小组学习:找一找还有那些单词中字母a的发音是/?/? 5.小组汇报交流并总结。
三、趣味操练(Practice)1.游戏:听一听,辩一辩。
教师读一组单词让学生听一听找出那个单词中没有a/?/的发音。如:bag
dad hand apple cake 2.游戏:击鼓传花
谁拿到花,必须说出一个含有字母a的单词。3.学写单词,并指导学生描红。
四、作业(Homework)听录音,给家长读单词。课 堂 检
测
一、读一读、听一听并圈一圈。 bag
dad
panda
dad
二、找出发音与众不同的单词。
Cat
Cake
dad plate Kate hand Canada cat ant
三、判断下列对话正误,正确的打“√”,错误的打“×”。()
1、A:Where are you from?
b: I’m Mike.()
1、A:Good afternoon?
b: Good morning.()
1、A:What’s her name?
b: My name is Jenny.课题
Unit 1 Welcome back to school!课型 新授课 课时 B-1 教 学 目
标 知识与技能:能听说认读单词:Australia,Canada,USA,China.主要通过情景对话学习如何询问别人的国籍以及回答,并在实际情景中自然运用。过程与方法:借助国家的国旗图片,帮助学生理解和认读国家名称。情感、态度和价值观:培养学生乐于模仿,敢于交流。重点
难点 国家名称的读音。
句型Where are you from?Australia的发音。学法
指导 学生活动 教具 学具 图片和单词卡片 通案 个案
一、热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)’s sing!2.日常口语练习: I’m ….I’m from China.二、新课展示(Presentation)
1.老师出示国旗图片,让学生认识,引出单词:Australia,USA,China,Canada。2.认读单词。
3.听录音或看课件认识不同国家的国旗,并跟读单词。4.学生小组讨论:这些图片中的国旗的特点和颜色。5.小组活动:把国旗和国家单词配对。看看谁最先完成。
教师出示事先准备好的国家国旗和单词图片等,一个人出示图片问:Where are you from?另一个人说:I’m from….让学生反复练习句子。6.听录音,跟读对话。
三、趣味操练(Practice)
1.两人一组用国旗或图片进行对话。2.自己创编对话。3.小组表演展示。
四、作业(Homework)
听录音跟读对话,熟记单词和国旗的特征。
课 堂 检
测
一、把图片和所属国家连线。
USA
China
Canada
Australia
二、能力提升: 1.你想问对方来自哪个国家时,你可以问: are you?
are you from?
are you from? is am from 月8日,你想对你的妈妈说:
Teachers’ Day! Women’s Day!
课题 Unit 1 Welcome back to school!课型 新授课 课时 B-2 教 学 目
标 知识与技能:听说认读单词she,he,student,pupil,teacher.能理解人称代词he she的不同用法,并能灵活运用。
过程与方法:借助图片和实际情况,帮助学生学习新单词。情感、态度和价值观:培养学生合作学习的能力。重点 难点
掌握单词的读音。
理解student和pupil的含义相同。学法
指导 学生活动 教具 学具
字母卡 单词卡 通案 个案
一、热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)1.日常口语复习:This is….2.复习boy和girl。
二、新课展示(Presentation)
1.教师利用简笔画画一个girl,引出句子She is a is Amy.帮助学生理解单词she。教师在补充:She is a student.出示单词卡片student(pupil),让学生猜单词的意思。2.教师利用简笔画画一个大男孩,引出句子He is a big is Mr Jones.帮助学生理解单词he。教师在补充:He is a teacher.出示单词卡片teacher,让学生猜单词的意思。3.播放Let’s learn部分的录音,让学生跟读。4.小组学习:看图片指认单词。
5.单词游戏:看图片认读单词,比比谁读的又快又准确。
三、趣味操练(Practice)1.游戏:
看图片说句子,看看谁说的多。2.游戏:击鼓传花
谁拿到花,必须用上英语单词he或she介绍自己的好朋友。3.听录音跟读Let’s chant!
四、作业(Homework)
听录音,给家长读单词和Let’s chant!
课 堂 检
测
一、看图把有关系的单词和图片连线。he girl
Pupil
boy
eacher
she
二、找出与众不同的单词。 she you boy girl pupil teacher
Canada Austrilia student
课题 Unit 1 Welcome back to school!课型 新授课 课时 B-3 6.知识与技能:能听懂并理解story time中的情节和故事内容。过程与方法:借助课件和表演帮助学生加深对小幽默故事的印象。情感、态度和价值观:培养学生乐于模仿,敢于交流。重点 难点
理解故事内容,并能表演出这个小幽默。学法
指导 学生活动 教具 学具 图片和单词卡片 通案 个案
一、热身/复习(Warm-up/Revision)’s sing!教材10页。2.日常口语复习句子
I’m a ’m from Wu’an.二、新课展示(Presentation)
1.老师出示课文挂图,让学生猜想发生了什么事情。2.教师播放课文录音,让学生听2遍。
3.学生回答教师的提问,Who are they?Who is clever? 并说说故事大概意思。4.听录音,跟读故事内容。
教师点拨重点词汇和口语:play a game,clever,wait a minute,Can you read this? 5.小组活动:
小组成员分角色朗读课文,并排练故事内容。6.小组展示:
小组上台表演故事,看看那组表演得好!
三、趣味操练(Practice) and number(10)’s and match.四、作业(Homework)听课文录音。
课 堂 检
测
一、读并判断对错。
is is my friend.()She is my friend.() is Miss is a techer.()She is a techer.() is Zhang is a student.()She is a student.(二、读句子,排一排。()Nice to meet you.()Good morning, is my friend, Amy.()I’m from America.()Good morning, Mike.()Where are you from? 文章 来源莲
山课件 w Y K M)
三年级英语下册课件 篇4
2.能够听懂、会说、会认读句型:Who's that man? He's my father. Nice to meet you. Nice to meet you, too.
3.能够根据家人的照片与同伴利用句型Who's that…? He's …/She's …来询问和介绍。
1.能够理解和运用句型:Who's that man? He's my father. Nice to meet you. Nice to meet you, too.
2.运用本课所学单词及句型进行交际对话练习。
教师:课件,有关家庭成员的图片、单词卡、教材相配套的教学视频。
教师利用图片或动画形式展示Main Scene 中的人物和两组小对话,让同学根据图片和对话内容掌握家庭成员名词,创设英语氛围。
教师让同学们分角色表演两段小对话,创设英语情景,让同学感受英语的语言氛围。
1.播放Unit 1 B Let's talk动画,让学生模仿表演。
2.学生3人一组做自由对话表演,激发学生的学习兴趣,培养学生的创造力。
(1)教师使用课件展示主情景图,让学生讨论此情景图的内容,引出话题“My family”。
(2)教师播放录音,让学生基本了解本单元的内容。
(1)教师:呈现Mr Jones的图片,问:Who's he?引导学生回答: He's Mr Jones.教师:Mr Jones is a man.
(2)学习单词man,并扩展woman进行对比学习。
(1)呈现教师本人父亲的照片:Look, that is a man. He's my father.
(2)学习father,并扩展mother对比学习。
(3)对比father和dad的用法,并扩展mother和mum对比学习。
(1)呈现动画对话。让学生跟读对话,呈现新句型。
(2)教学句型:Who's that man? He's my father.
(3)学生小组表演对话。
(1)教师呈现课本中Point and say部分的教学挂图。
(2)让同桌之间利用自己准备的照片练习句型:Who's that man? He's my father/friend/…
(3)教师请学生拿出自己准备的爸爸的照片,两人一组,介绍自己的爸爸。
收集学生爸爸的照片,教师说:“Who's that man?”并把球丢出去给其中一名学生,是谁的爸爸,谁就快速回答:He's my father.否则就把球丢给下一名学生,接到球的学生必须在限定时间内回答问题并问下一名学生同样的问题“Who's that man?”逾时则被判出局。
3.完成全品学练考―课后练11页第一题。
师生一起回顾本课时所学内容:
句型:Who's that man? He's my father.
Nice to meet you.
Nice to meet you, too.
1.听对话并熟读对话。
―Who's that man? ―He's my father.
Hi, Dad. This is my friend, Amy.
who意为“谁”,用来引导特殊疑问句。
Who+is/are+主语?这一句型表示“……是谁?”
如:Who is that boy? 那个男孩是谁?
2.Who's that man?那个男人是谁?
that 那个,离说话人远的那个。
this这个,离说话人近的这个。
本节课是第二单元的第一课时,本节课的主要内容是学会句型“Who's that man? He's my…”所以本节课可采取情景模拟、角色扮演的形式来教授。通过这样生动、真实的情景,让学生积极主动地参与到课堂活动中,发挥了学生的主体作用。在“烫手山芋”这一环节,课堂效果特别好,同学们根据各个爸爸不同的特征,熟练地掌握了物主代词和人称代词在句子中的运用,同时,提高了学生的口语表达能力和运用英语进行交流的能力。
1. 能够听、说、认读单词: father, dad, man, woman, mother, mum。
2.能够听、说、认读句型:Who's that woman? She's my mother.
3.能够听录音并跟唱Let's chant部分内容。
掌握三会单词和句子: father, dad, man, woman, mother, mum, Who's that woman? She's my mother.进行对话练习。
能够理解和运用句型:Who's that woman? She's my mother.
教师:有关家庭成员的图片、教材相配套的教学录音及课件。
教师和同学一起哼唱Let's chant 部分的小歌谣,让同学在轻松愉悦的氛围中掌握英语单词和英语句子。
教师利用简笔画展示:father, man, dad, woman, mother, mum,然后分别找不同的同学进行对话练习:Who's that woman? She's my mother.
1.唱歌曲Father and mother。
2.读自编的Let's chant:
Man, man, who's that man?
Father, father, he's my father.
Woman, woman, who's that woman?
Mum, mum, she's my mum.
三年级英语下册课件 篇5
活动设计背景
由于我班是少数民族幼儿居多,所以在教学目标上相比汉族幼儿可能会降低一些。只要求他们掌握简单的单词即可。所以这节课我的活动设计我会根据不同的幼儿去按不同的标准去要求他们。
活动目标
活动目标:
1、理解单词含义,学说新单词。
2、感受英语游戏的`快乐,愿意学英语。
教学重点、难点
能看图说单词,能用英语和教师进行简单的交流。
活动准备
活动准备:
1、木偶一个。
2、红苹果、绿橘子、黄香蕉、蓝气球各一个。
3、红、绿、黄、蓝颜色颜料、可乐瓶子两个
活动过程:
一、复习颜色单词,引出活动。
以木偶和幼儿打招呼,复习上次活动单词,并引出新单词。
师:1、“Hello Hello”是谁在和小朋友打招呼啊?(Mary)
2、出示红苹果What’s this?(这是什么?)苹果是什么颜色的呢?用英语怎么说?
3、出示绿橘子What’s this?那这个又是什么颜色的呢?用英语说。
4、小朋友真棒,表扬表扬自己。(Very Very Good)
二、学习新单词。
1、yellow
Mary拿出黄香蕉,What’s this? 它是什么颜色的?黄色的英语叫“yellow”,全体幼儿看着香蕉跟着老师说“yellow”,走一圈请幼儿边摸香蕉边说“yellow”并采用变换高低请幼儿用不同音量读单词。
2、blue
Mary出示蓝气球,What’s this? 它的颜色是什么?蓝色叫“blue”,全体幼儿看着气球跟着老师说“blue”,教师利用吹气球的方式请幼儿根据气球大小用不同音量来读单词,然后再放气慢慢变小来读,可请配班老师帮着吹气球,老师带着幼儿读,注意停顿,并读清楚。
3、分组读单词.....................
@@@@
一、活动内容:字母Y,短语Good night
二、活动目标:
1、通过多种游戏形式学习字母Y,知道Y,Y,拉链Y;
Y for yellow,学习短语:Good night.复习Good morning.
2、引导幼儿读准字母单词的发音,培养对英语活动的热情和兴趣。
三、活动准备:
字母Y卡片、带有拉链的衣服、饮料瓶三个(瓶盖涂上黄色颜料)、小扇子(正反面各有太阳和月亮)
四、活动过程:
1、问好:
(1) 师生问好。
(2) 引导幼儿向家长老师们问好。
2、热身:Hands up , hands down.
3、正课:
(1) 学习字母Y:
让幼儿Close your eyes, 出示字母卡片Y,说明Y很象拉链,引出YY拉链Y,并通过游戏“修拉链”训练幼儿的发音。接着出示黄色饮料,说明Y的好朋友是yellow,通过游戏“变魔术”训练Y for yellow.
(2) 学习短语Good night。
A、 手指游戏:手指变魔术很累了,要睡觉了,跟它们说:“Good night.” 天亮了,要起床了,说:“Good morning.”
B、 游戏:小扇子转转转
出示扇子,转到月亮说:“Good night.”转到太阳说:“Good morning.” 说得好的给予粘粘纸奖励。
4、叮咛:
出示英语书,引导说:“open the book.” 交代复习今天所学内容内容,并记得听磁带。
教学反思
这节课上下来让我感觉师幼配合上还不够默契,幼儿能基本达到这节课的教学目标,能看图说话,但在和老师交流上还不够流畅。还需要反复练习和巩固。
三年级英语下册课件 篇6
1.复习巩固单词:woman, man, student, boy, girl。
复习巩固句型:Who's that man/woman/boy? He's/She's…
2.学会唱The cat is from the UK。
3.能够在Find and circle活动中找出含a, e, i的单词,并大声读出来。
会根据图片和句型谈论Sarah's family。
教师:与本课时相关的录音、字母、单词卡片、课件。
教师和学生一起唱The cat is from the UK,来认识这只可爱的小猫,从而进一步巩固所学形容词。
同学两人一组,寻找单词,看谁找到的单词数量最多。以此提高学生的观察能力,不断培养学生学习英语的兴趣。
1.教师讲解作业,对学生易出错误的地方加以强化,指导学习。
教师每说出三个单词,学生听音找出相同的音素,复习三年级上册学过的字母与音素的歌谣。如:
(1)Dad, bag, panda, what is the same sound? Which letter sounds //?
(2)Ten, leg, pencil, what is the same sound? Which letter sounds /e/?…
Look and tick.
1.组织学生观察图片。
2.看图认读单词完成练习。
3.看图,完成学生课本第34页的活动。
4.两人一组看图说话:Find Sarah's family. Who is not here?
三年级英语下册课件 篇7
一、教学目标
(一)知识与技能
1.能听说认读以下单词:tall, short, fat, thin。
2.能运用所学形容词来描述动物的特征。
3.能听懂指令,并根据指令做出相应的动作。
4.能按正确格式书写单词。
(二)过程与方法
通过看口型、听音辨音等形式来反复练习单词。
(三)情感、态度与价值观
教育学生要以正确的态度对待别人,不要以貌取人。
二、教学重难点
教学重点:
能运用所学形容词来描述动物的特征。
教学难点:
单词thin的发音。
三、教学策略
游戏是儿童的天堂。做游戏可以满足他们好动好玩的心理,这样小学生的注意力会持久、稳定。因此,把游戏应用于英语词汇教学中不仅能为词汇学习创造出逼真的、富于交际性的语言环境,而且能为学生提供引人入胜的词汇练习形式。运用形象生动的课件也可以把教学内容具体形象化、简单化、生动化,迎合了小学生的好奇心。这样,学生在轻松愉快的状态下,加深了词汇的感知印象,为永久记住词汇打下基础。
三年级英语下册课件 篇8
教学内容:Lesson 1 课时序数:1 授课日期:
课型:对话课
学习目标:1.能在情景中理解会说,I’m,并能够在正式的环境中初步运用 2.能够听、说、认、读单词cat、monkey并充分理解其意义。
教学重点:充分了解打招呼Hello/Hi用于初次见面的好朋友,并学会介绍自己,利用句 型I’m进行自我介绍。
教学难点:单词cat/monkey的发音以及对此意义的理解运用。 教学准备:教学课件、卡片、相关的动物图,录音机,头饰等
教学过程:
:课前播放歌曲Hello, 渲染课堂学习的气氛。
: a.以自然的方式向学生说Hello, 引导学生向老师说Hello, Hello,表示问候。然后让学生相互用Hello! 练习问好。 b.让学生到讲台上来,戴上Li Yan 的头饰说 Hello, I’m 然后请学生向老师进行真实的自我介绍。 c. 向学生出示本课书的教学挂图并提供话题情景:清晨,校园里来了一个外国小学生,同学们和他热情地打招呼。同时借助挂图,提问:Look, what’s this ? 并将贴在树后的动物图片进行移动,然后戴上面具说:Hi , I’m Mimi. Hello, I’m Mimi. d. 听录音,让学生跟读,并要求学生用手指者句子、单词来认读。
3、Practice: 找朋友:将学生分成里外两个圆圈,听音乐转圈,每当音乐停止时,让里外圈的小朋友面对面相互问好并进行自我介绍。
4、Homework: 听本课录音,熟读本课课文及单词并应用所学对话进行交流。
板书
Lesson 1
cat
Hi! I’m monkey
教学内容:Lesson 2
课时序数:2
授课日期: 课型:对话课
学习目标:a、Just speak:本部分通过情景会话,让学生用“ What’s your name?” 询问对方的姓名并回答。 b、Just read:学习有关动物的单词:dog , duck。 c、Let’s sing:学唱歌曲What’s your name?巩固本课教学内容。
教学重点:a、熟练的使用“ What’s your name?”句型进行交流。 b、掌握dog , duck两单词。
教学难点:What’s your name?的句型运用及发音。
教学准备:图片、投影、录音机
教学过程:
A、Revision a、课前播放歌曲What’s your name?渲染课堂学习的活跃气氛。 b、唱 Hello 歌 c、学生起立做自我介绍。
B、Presentation a、教师首先做自我介绍,如:My name is Feng Wenlian.大声重复几遍。接着以自然的方式问一名学生:“ What’s your name?”(用清晰、缓慢的语调问两遍)边问边指用口型提示他回答My name is,用类似的方法在教师里与学生进行问答练习,引导他们用My name is进行互相问答,注意 name 一词的发音。 b、向学生出示本课书的教学挂图,借助该挂图,复现上一节课的小动物。在巩固复习的基础上引出新的单词dog , duck.。教师可以戴上动物的.头饰介绍:Hello! I’m a dog. My name is Doggy. What’s your name? Hi! I’m duck. My name is Ducky.,并请同学戴上小动物的头饰进行对话。 c、听录音,用投影展示句型和生单词的教学内容,让学生听录音,跟读,并要求学生用手指着句单词进行认读,力求做到“眼到、手到、口到、心到”,体会其英语句意。
C、Practice a、将学生分成四个动物代表队,进行课文对话表演,比一比,看一看,哪组同学创设的场景最好,表情丰富,语句运用充分得体,为他们颁发最佳表演奖。 b、利用玩扑克牌的形式将学生快速分组进行找朋友的游戏,持有不同花色相同数字的学生有走到一起,互相问候并询问姓名。c、两个学生高举手臂筑成拱桥,播放歌曲What’s your name?,当音乐停止时,哪一个学生落到桥下,参与游戏的全体学生都要问What’s your name?请他回答。
D、教唱歌曲What’s your name? E、Homework: 听录音,模仿会话,并在实际情景中运用所学的内容。请学生利用课余时间做调查,用英语询问家庭相关成员的姓名。
板书
Lesson 2
What’s your name?
My name’s dog/duck
三年级英语下册课件 篇9
【题目】
Unit6 At the zoo?第一课时
【教学目标】
1.能听、说、读写几个形容词small,big,long,short,并能在情境中灵活得当的使用。
2.听懂含有形容词的几个指令,并按指令做动作。
【教学重点】
词汇:small,big,long,short。
【教学难点】
单词的准确发音与使用。
【教学准备】
1.与本课时相关的教学挂图和配套录音。
2.教师和学生都准备动物图片和单词卡。
3.教师给学生准备作为奖励的小礼物。
【教学过程】
Step1:Warm-up
1.教师热情地和学生打招呼问好,并和学生做简单的FreeTalk.,让学生提问教师或者同学,通过让学生自主提问复习旧知识,既改变了以往师问生答的模式,又融洽了师生关系,同时让学生在轻松的对话中将角色带到英语课堂的学习中来。
2.教师通过媒体资源播放前面学习的英语歌曲《Hide and Seek》,老师带学生在音乐旋律的伴奏下边说边做动作,创造学习英语的氛围,让学生在轻松快乐的气氛中开始今天的英语学习。
Step2:Presentation
1.教师拿出事先准备好的小球,对学生说:“Look at this ball.Is big or small?”学生回答“Small”教师说:Yes.It’s small.边说边板书ball,并在ball的下面写出small.出示单词卡,教学生认读small。同样,可以出示一张肥猪的图片,从“The pig is big”一句,引导学生比较pig和big两个单词。然后出示单词卡片,教学生认读big.教师通过以旧带新的方法学习生词,可以使学生掌握拼读规则,从而掌握正确的学习和记忆单词的`方法,大大提高了学生的学习兴趣,使课堂教学效率大大提高。
2.教师通过对monkey和rabbit的尾巴,复习long和short.出示单词卡,让学生认读单词long和short.
3.教师通过媒体资源给学生呈现出“Let’s learn”的教学内容,让学生跟读单词。
4.学生看完一遍之后,图文的完美结合大大帮助了学生对单词的识记。教师可以将这些单词卡片逐一举起,请学生以多种有趣的方式进行读说练习。练习中教师要注意及时纠正学生的发音错误,力求学生每个单词读得清楚、准确,帮助学生正确掌握所学新知。
5.教师觉得同学们对这些单词已经基本掌握的时候,播放媒体资源中“Let’s do”的内容。让学生模仿画面中的动作,说说做做。
教师播放资源内容,学生模仿说说做做,之后教师可以说上半句,引导学生很快地说出下半句并做出相应的动作,做动作时尽量夸张,让学生体验英语学习的快乐。
Step3:Practice
1.教师通过媒体资源给学生呈现出本部分的对点练习,请学生仔细听录音。认真看图,然后根据录音内容对示意图做出判断,正确的打勾,错误的打叉。学生做完后订正答案。
2.教师引导学生做游戏“超级录音机”
教师向每组的第一名学生耳语一个指令,如:Tall,tall,tall!Make yourself tall.这名学生依次向组里的下一个同学耳语这个指令,以此类推,直至最后一个同学。最后这位同学快步跑上讲台根据指令做动作,哪个小组既快又准,就为本小组赢得一分,教师对本组同学给与一定形式的奖励。
3.教师和学生玩游戏“Quickresponse”
教师做动作,学生很快说出教师做动作的反义词。如教师做出tall的动作,学生应该很快地说出short。当学生熟练之后,由师生互动转为生生互动。让那个学生在游戏中巩固所学。
Step4:Summary
教师和学生一起总结本课时的教学重点,巩固新知。
Step5:Homework
1.复习本课时所学的单词。
2.将Let’sdo的内容说给爸爸妈妈听,并和他们一起做动作。
三年级英语下册课件 篇10
一、教学目标 :
1、能听懂、会说本课会话;
2、能运用“How are you?”进行问候,并对此做出回应;力求在第一课堂就激发学生学习英语的兴趣。
二、教学重点及难点:
重点:自我介绍, 运用“How are you?”向他人询问情况。
难点:根据自身的实际情况回答“I’m fine,thank you.”、“No, I’m not very well.”
三、教学步骤:
Step 1 Warming up
师生问候。
T: Good morning, boys and girls.
S: Good morning, Miss Jiang. 用中文或动作帮助学生回忆、理解。
Step 2 Presentation and drill
1.T: Hello, boys and girls. Iam your English teacher. I am Miss Jiang. 用动作帮助写生回忆、巩固“Iam „”的意义。
T: Today we’ll learn Unit 1 “How areyou?” 板书课题及主题句。带读单词“unit”、“one”. 会话教学
2.先教单词fine.教师指着自己对学生说:I’m fine today. 用表情来表示出自己今天很好(指身体)。并把fine一词写在黑板上,可向学生用汉语解释fine一词意思是身体好。
3.教师反复带读fine一词并检查学生的发音.
4. 教师和一个学生打招呼:Hello, how areyou? 然后指着黑板上fine 一词,启发学生回答:I’m fine, thanks或 I’m fine, thank you.
5. 教师再和另一位学生重复刚才的会话.
6. 让一个学生向老师打招呼并问候,如: S: Hello, Miss„„ How are you? T: Fine ,thanks.教师接着问候学生:How are you启发学生回答,同时教I’m fine, thank you.
7. 教师把very well.写在黑板上.解释very well意思是身体好.
8. 教师带读very well ,并检查学生发音.
9. 师生之间进行打招呼问候,如
T: Morning, boys and girls.
Ss: Morning, Mr. Zhang. How are you?
T: Fine, thanks. How are you?
Ss: Very well, thank you.
10. 同桌两人或前后两人进行会话练习.
11. 听会话录音,模仿语音语调.。
T: Hello, I’m Miss Jiang. 放慢速度,强调口型,帮助学生理解“How areyou?”并能根据自身实际情况估出回答。
12.听课文A部分录音,跟读。
Step 3 Practice
游戏——A little actor 准备一个纸盒,装入写有Anne,Lingling, Peter, Mingming等人名的纸条。学生抽中谁,就扮演谁,进行角色表演。
游戏——Dragon game Step 4Consolidation
创设情境,自由会话。评价。练习:《练习册》P1
七年级英语上册课件八篇
探究与“七年级英语上册课件”有关的主题是本文的关注点。教案课件是老师上课做的提前准备,因此想要随便写的话老师们就要注意了。教案是教学评价的重要依据。希望这些资料能供你参考和使用欢迎分享给需要的人!
七年级英语上册课件(篇1)
单词水平测试九
班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________
1. Beijing is the c _______________ of the P.R.C as well as the centre of China’s political matters and culture.
2. She wore sun-glasses so that I didn’t r _______________ her at the first sight.
3. Smoking is strictly f _______________ in the gas station.
4. The sunlight is a kind of limitless e _______________ for us to use.
5. He was w _______________ so that we couldn’t hear what he was saying.
6. Children are taught to believe in the _______________ (原则) of equal opportunity for everyone.
7. His work this week hasn’t been up to his usual _______________ (水准).
8. I know your back hurts, but you have to wait _______________ (耐心地) until the doctor arrives.
9. In fact, he felt the condition even _______________ (糟糕) than before.
10. The doctor are busy _______________ (做手术) on the wounded soldier now.
11. The a _______________ of air can easily cause a man to die.
12. Cancer is a kind of disease which is almost i _______________.
13. Please follow these sentence p _______________ to make a few sentences.
14. His teacher asked him not to be c _______________ with himself with a little success.
15. She was e _______________ to that man but got married to this man.
16. The girl was so _______________ (着迷) by the mighty river that she would spend hours sitting on its bank and watching the boats going and coming.
17. It being very hot, the boy had to stand in the _______________ (阴凉处).
18. The city of Nanjing _______________ (目暏) the cruelty of the Japanese invaders.
19. Look, our troops are _______________ (接近) the enemy’s position and will soon attack them.
20. It said that that plane _______________ (坠毁) in the valley.
单词水平测试十
班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________
1. What he says is not in h _______________ with what he does.
2. Before taking action, be sure to get p _______________ from your parents.
3. In China the a _______________ population takes up a large part of the whole population.
4. A $ 1,000 r _______________ has been offered for the return of the stolen painting.
5. It doesn’t seem ugly to me; on the c _______________, I think it’s rather beautiful.
6. The models are kept in locked cases as they are too valuable and _______________ (易碎的) for classroom use.
7. Although he was _______________ (残疾的) when he was only ten years of age, yet he aimed high, for which his classmates spoke highly of him.
8. Finally, Chairman made a short speech, _______________ (结束时说) that the plan should be carried out soon.
9. In Britain, some abandoned cats and dogs will be _______________ (收养) by kind-hearted people.
10. It rained _______________ (连续的) for seven days, completely ruining our holiday.
11. As far as I know, that country c _______________ of many tiny islands.
12. I can’t s _______________ my dictionary with you. I don’t like someone else to use it.
13. SARS is a kind of disease s _______________ very quickly.
14. There are seven c _______________ and four oceans in the earth.
15. Volleyball is played t _______________ the world.
16. Smoking _______________ (香烟) is harmful to our health.
17. I’ll _______________ (推荐) you a good book which will give you a lot of knowledge.
18. You’d better have all the programmes _______________ (简化) .
19. We gave our classroom a _______________ (彻底) cleaning before the National Day.
20. There will be a large apple _______________ (收成) in my hometown this year.
单词水平测试九
1. capital 2. recognize 3. forbidden 4. energy 5. whispering 6. principle 7. standard 8. patiently 9. worse 10. operating 11. absence 12. incurable 13. patterns 14. content 15. engaged 16. fasinated 17. shade 18. witnessed 19. approaching 20. crashed
单词水平测试十
1. harmony 2. permission 3. agricultural 4. reward 5. contrary 6. fragile 7. disabled 8. concluding 9. adopted 10. continuously 11. consist of 12. share 13. spreading 14. continents 15. throughout 16. cigrettes 17. recommend 18. simplified 19. thorough 20. harvest
七年级英语上册课件(篇2)
电子课件就是全部输入在电脑中的,通常也都是教师自己上课所背的内容。这里讲的教案与传统上的有很大的不同,下面为大家分享了七年级上册英语的电子课件,欢迎借鉴!
1.学习本课的知识点:
(2)单词:blue,green,red,yellow,black,white,brown,purple,co lor,UFO,CCTV
(3)句型:
—What's this/that?
—It's ...
—What color is it?
—It's ...
2.使学生能运用所学英语,正确地描述物体的颜色。
3.对学生进行美育教育,从小培养他们对美的正确认识。
熟练掌握Ss—Zz八个字母的大小写形式和颜色的表达方法。
这一部分的Guessing game主要是为了让学生从不完整的画面中通过想象,猜出其是什么字母,既复习学过的字母,又丰富学生的想象力。而“What's this?It's ...”既是前一单元的重点句型,也是下一课时使用频率较高的一个句型。我们在游戏的最后用同样的方式引出本堂课所要教授的新字母的小写形式。
For example:
The teacher shows a part of a letter and asks:
Get the students to answer the question like this:
Then show the whole of the letter to let the students check whether they're right or wrong.
导入新课What color is it?
通过字母卡片,复习前面学到的字母及交际用语。
让同学们拿着卡片互相问答。
教师用红色粉笔在黑板上写“A”,询问学生:
The teacher answers himself/herself: It's red.
教师使用不同颜色的粉笔在黑板上写下字母Aa—Rr,让同学们一个接一个地读出来,教师问:
Ss:It's red.(Help the students to answer.)
导入新课 What color is it?
建议3:
T:Good morning,boys and girls.
Good morning,A.
Good morning,B.
(Greet as many students as possible individually.)
T:What color are your clothes?
T:Good.Now please ask and answer questions with your partner about the color of your clothes.
导入新课 What color is it?
Step 2:Present the new letters and words
1.教师通过多媒体呈现一组本课要学习的字母图片,并且每张字母图片颜色不一样,让学生以小组为单位进行辨认。教师可采取竞赛的方式来调动学生的学习积极性。
For example:
T:Look at these pictures.Let's play a game.Who can say these letters and the colors as quickly as possible?If you can,you will be the winner.Now let's begin.
Get some students to ask each other about letters and colors in English,and then do 1a:let the students write the letters for each color.The teacher can offer some help.
2.读一读表示颜色的单词,然后把颜色与对应的单词连起来。
T:They are the names of colors.Draw them on the blackboard or show them on the screen.Now please read after me.You should pay attention to your pronunciation.
Let's match the words with the colors.
建议:
教学过程中我们可以设计一个任务型活动为顺藤摸瓜。在学生学习了有关颜色的词汇后,作为拓展,向学生介绍几个新的表示颜色的词汇,如:dark/light green,orange,pink。这几个词较常见,也很实用。然后通过顺藤摸瓜的游戏加以巩固。具体操作为:
准备10个乒乓球,乒乓球染成10种不同的颜色,然后将10个乒乓球放在一个开口的纸盒子里。上课时,教师找一个学生背对着大家,放音乐,音乐一开始,大家就开始传盒子,音乐一停,手拿盒子的同学马上拿出一个球举起。问控制音乐的同学 “What color is it?” 他猜:“It's red.”。若猜对了,大家说yes,控制音乐的学生继续放音乐;如果大家说“No,it's blue.”,控制音乐的学生下台,由刚才拿球的学生来控制音乐。游戏继续,直到乒乓球在不同学生手里。可以多练几次,让学生充分掌握表示颜色的单词。
该活动参照击鼓传花的游戏而创造。可操作性强,学生积极性也高。能让学生在不知不觉中掌握表示颜色的单词。
1.教师让学生听1b部分的录音,通过听力训练操练所学的新句型。
具体操作建议是:第一遍 让学生只是听,第二遍让学生听并跟读,然后教师让学生进行操练,先学生齐读,然后把学生分成组齐读,最后让个别学生读。通过这种从整体到部分再到个体的机械操练,让学生掌握本课所学的新句型。
2.教师板书并强调What question 句型。
A:What color is it? B:It's red.
A:What color is it? B:It's black.
1.让学生先按照课本的内容练习,建议前后位互问,同位互问,一生随意选择另一学生互问,尽量采取多形式从多角度练习,让更多 的人参与进来。
2.Pa ir work:Let's look at the pictures below.Can you ask and answer questions about the colors?Now work in pairs.Ask your partner about the letters in the pictures.
3.脱离课本,让学生根据身边的事物进行问答,或者用彩笔在白纸上随意写出学过的字母进行问答。
建议1:先复习前面两个单元学过的字母,再过渡到本节课要学习的新字母。
For example:
Please look at the letters.Let's practice saying the letters Aa—Rr in order.
Aa,Bb,Cc,Dd,Ee,Ff,Gg,Hh,Ii,Jj,Kk,Ll,Mm,Nn,Oo,Pp,Qq,Rr
Good.Look at the letters in 2a.They are letters Ss—Zz.Let's listen and repeat them.Pay attention to the pronunciation of the long /i?/sound in T and V and the short /e/ sound in S and Z.The /v/ sounds in V doesn't exist in most Chinese dialects.You should pay special attention.You can't say that like /veI/ or /weI/./zi?/is American English and is also acceptable.
OK.Let's listen and repeat them.
建议2:
1.第一遍让学生只是听,第二遍让学生听并跟读,然后教师让学生进行操练,先学生齐读,然后把学生分成组齐读,最后让个别学生读。通过这种从整 体到部分再到个体的机械操练,让学生掌握本课所学的新字母。
2.教师出示一些带有字母的卡片,并涂上颜色,让学生任意抽取一张,读出字母和表示卡片颜色的单词。为了培养学生的竞争意识,也可以让学生以组为单位进行比赛,每个组选一名代表,看哪个组读得准,读得响亮。
Look at the letters in 2b.They are not arranged alphabetically.Now listen to the tape and number the letters in order,and then read them aloud.
仔细观察2c中字母大小写书写格式,并抄写。教师仔细观察同学们的书写情况,针对存在的`问题及时在黑板上反馈。
建议1:教师在黑板上画出四线格,先演示给同学们看。
建议2:利用投 影仪,以动态的形式展示给同学们看。
根据大写字母写出小写字母,根据小写字母写出大写字母,必须使用四线格。
写完之后找同学读一读,再次巩固字母的读音。对于书写比较漂亮的同学,教师将其书写投影,供大家学习,同时也能激励大家认真书写。
建议:这个游戏叫“非常接触”。在活动前先向学生介绍字母大小写的规则。通过活动——非常接触加以巩固。以每一排为一组,将全班分成若干组,教师分别发给每组最后一排的学生一张纸片,上面写有一个字母,只允许这个学生看这个字母,在教师说“开始”后,最后一排的学生即用手指把纸片上的字母写在前面学生的背上……这样依次进行下去,最后第一排的学生把所传的字母写到黑板的四线格上,传得最快最准确的组获胜。
这一部分并不一定要学生掌握这些缩略词的完整的拼法,主要是为了让学生了解可以运用学过的大写字母来表示一些常见的缩略词或缩写形式。老师也可以补充一些常见的缩略词。
For example:
T:Have you seen these abbreviations?Do you know what they stand for?Now let's look at the pic tures and abbreviations and discuss in groups.
1.小组讨论,展示答案。
2.展示各小组课前收集的缩略词,看看哪组收集得多。
3.教师在屏幕上多展示一些缩略词,让同学们多了解一些。
本课我们主要学习了red,white,yellow,black等表示颜色的单词,S—Z八个字母的读音及大小写形式,还学习了“What color is it?It's red.”两个句型。难点是准确而熟练地描述物体的颜色。在第二课时的学习中我们会继续使用这两个句型进行语言交际。
1.把Ss—Zz八个字母的大小写形式每个写5遍。
2.制作彩色字母卡片,并在卡片上写出本节课学习的句型。
1.What color is it?它是什么颜色的?
【用法透析】该句型结构为“What color +be +名词(代词)+?”用来问某物是什么颜色。
这是对颜色进行提问的特殊疑问句。what是疑问代词,可放在名词前修饰说明名词(color),该句的主语是it,所以动词用单数is,若主语是复数的,则动词用are。该句答语为“It's/They're+颜色.”
2.It's black.它是黑色的。
【用法透析】it是代词,指代前面所提到的东西或人。
【误区警示】注意:its易与it's混淆。it's是it is的缩略式,意思是“它是”,用时要注意以下几点:
①在句首时it's 和it is 两者可以通用。例如:
It's/It is a pen.它是一支钢笔。
That is a car.It's an English car.那是一辆汽车,它是一辆英国生产的汽车。
②作肯定回答时,在Yes之后只能用it is,而不能用it's。如:
—Is this a pen?这是只钢笔吗?
Starter Unit 3 What color is it?
blue,green,red,yellow,black,white,brown,purple,color
What color is it?
It's red...
七年级英语上册课件(篇3)
一、作者简介
巴金,现代著名作家。原名李尧棠,字芾甘,19生于四川成都。建国后曾任中国文联副主席,中国作家协会副主席、主席,作协上海分会主席,上海文联主席,《收获》主编。主要作品有:长篇小说《爱情三部曲》(《雾》《雨》《电》),《激流三部曲》(《家》《春》《秋》);中篇小说《憩园》,《寒夜》;散文集《保卫和平的人们》,《友谊集》,《随想录》;散文、小说、特写集《新声集》,《赞歌集》,还有不少短篇小说、童话、杂文等。
二、《繁星》的写作背景
这篇文章选自巴金的《海上杂记》。1923年,19岁的巴金和三哥毅然冲破封建家庭的樊笼到了上海,南京,考入东南大学附中补习班。在学习期间,参加了一些社会活动,著名的五卅运动对他的影响较大,他的民主思想得到进一步发展。1927年1月15日,他乘法国轮船昂热号离沪赴法,卫惠林同行,先后同船的中国学生计9人。他去法国是为了学习经济学,向西方找真理,进一步研究无政府主义理论,考察欧洲的社会活动。法国既是无政府主义的发源地,也是当时欧洲的政治流放者的庇护所。2月18日,昂热号邮轮抵达马赛。19日巴金抵达巴黎。在邮船航行期间,巴金撰写了《海上杂记》38则。《繁星》是其中的一篇游记,写于1927年1月。
七年级英语上册课件(篇4)
一、教学目标
1、知识目标
(1)学习并掌握描述天气的词汇:rainy、windy、sunny、cloudy、snowy
(2)掌握句型结构:
—How is the weather(in +地点)?/What’s the weather like?(in +地点)?
—It’s rainy/windy/sunny/cloudy/snowy.2、能力目标
学会使用本单元的单词和句型询问天气并作出恰当的应答。
3、情感目标
(1)通过小组合作完成任务,培养学生团结合作的意识。
(2)通过谈论天气,了解一些地理常识。
(3)通过学习天气,培养学生的乐观积极向上的心态。
二、教学重难点
1、教学重点
(1)描述天气的词汇:rainy、windy、sunny、cloudy、snowy
(2)掌握句型结构:
—How is the weather(in +地点)? /What’s the weather like?(in +地点)?
—It’s rainy/windy/sunny/cloudy/snowy.2、教学难点
(1)名词转换形容词的构词法:sun—sunny、rain—rainy、wind—windy、cloud—cloudy、snow—snowy
(2)国外城市的读音和拼音
三、教学方法
教师采用任务型教学方法让学生主动参与小组合作探究,迅速有效地开展各项活动。
四、教学辅助工具:黑板、多媒体设备
五、教学过程:
1、热身运动
(1)师生共唱“rain? go? away”, 活跃课堂气氛。
(2)做个模拟下雨的游戏,引出本课有关天气的话题。
2、导入生词:
(1)以weather为中心词,让学生进行头脑风暴,回忆有关天气的词汇,然后观看PPT图片导入本课新单词:rainy、windy、sunny、cloudy、snowy
(2)教师带读,让学生熟记单词。
3、呈现句型
(1)给出句型结构:
—How is the weather(in +地点)? /What’s the weather like?(in +地点)?
—It’s rainy/windy/sunny/cloudy/snowy.(2)分别用两个句型进行游戏比赛,让学生在游戏中反复巩固新句型和新知识点。
4、听力练习,课本37页,1b5、PPT呈现中国气象地图,让学生小组讨论并抽代表上讲台模拟天气预报,并作出评价。
6、课堂总结:总结本节课所学单词和句型
7、课堂练习
8、情感升华
六、教学反思
1、课堂板书设计得应该更能适合本节课的总结这一环节,以后注意板书的书写
2、课堂口语需加强,有些突发状况还不能立即用英语表达。
七年级英语上册课件(篇5)
单词水平测试七
班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________
1. French is one of the o _______________ languages in Canada.
2. If you taste the sea water, you’ll find it s _______________.
3. He has broken the agreement by not doing the work he p _______________.
4. I know you are very busy, but if you can m _______________ to come on Saturday afternoon, I shall be very thankful.
5. A good p _______________ is very important for a teacher of English who teaches small children.
6. A national conference will be held next _______________ (周三) to discuss the economic problems.
7. The hostess takes pride in careful _______________ (准备) of special dishes.
8. While they were away from home, they put all their valuable in the bank, just for _______________ (安全).
9. Mr. Smith turns lawyer but Mr. Brown _______________ (仍然) a worker.
10. Susan is talkative, but she never talks to _______________ (陌生人) .
11. I can’t go to the party, but I’m going to have some flowers d _______________ for her birthday.
12. The picture shows four g _______________, great grandfather, grandfather, parents and baby.
13. My English teacher always e _______________ me when I meet with difficulties.
14. The c _______________ made me worn out when I reached the top of the mountain.
15. I’ll have to buy a pair of t _______________ to match my new T-shirt.
16. Robin is a cold-blooded killer; he has _______________ (谋杀) a lot of people.
17. The worst part of the divorce was the _______________ (分离) from his three children. He wanted to be with them.
18. The show had a very large audience, _______________ (范围) from children to grandparents.
19. Do you think the teaching in _______________ (私人的) schools is better than in state schools?
20. Your plan sounds good, and it you raise the plan at the meeting I’ll _______________ (支持) you.
单词水平测试八
班级 ______________ 姓名 ______________ 分数 ______________
1. My brother enjoys c _______________ stamps.
2. You seem to have a fever. Let me take your t _______________.
3. The air around the earth is called a _______________.
4. What he said e _______________ me greatly and I made up my mind to continue learning.
5. The manager can speak several f _______________ languages.
6. Dreams are just _______________ (记忆) to be.
7. Nowadays most people use paper _______________ (手帕) .
8. Nie Haishen and Fei Jun long have become _______________ (熟悉的) faces to millions of fans of space travel.
9. Not surprisingly, praise usually makes children _______________ (提高) greatly.
10. The boy spoke in a very low voice _______________ (承认) he had broken the glass.
11. When a soldier meets an officer, the soldier often s _______________ him.
12. When the crops are r _______________, they are ready to be harvested.
13. The fridge does not f _______________ very well; you’d better get it repaired.
14. I know you are very busy. Would you mind s _______________ me a few minutes?
15. A bicycle is far more c _______________ than a car or a bus in busy cities.
16. The car accident has caused _______________ damage to Mary’s eyesight; she will not be able to see things for the rest of her life.
17. Hand _______________ () is the small bags that you carry with you when you are traveling on a plane.
18. The boy was happy to see many colorful _______________ () go up into the sky.
19. Although the painting looked old, it’s really a _______________ ().
20. One of his _______________ () is to become the CEO of the international company.
Key
单词水平测试七
1. official 2. salty 3. promised 4. manage 5. pronunciation 6. Wednesday 7. preparation 8. safety 9. remains 10. strangers 11. delivered 12. generations 13. encourages 14. climbing 15. trousers 16. murdered 17. separation 18. ranging 19. private 20. support
单词水平测试八
1. collecting 2. temperature 3. atmosphere 4. encouraged 5. foreign 6. memories 7. handkerchiefs 8. familiar 9. improve 10. admitting 11. salutes 12. ripe 13. function 14. sparing 15. convenient 16. permanent 17. luggage 18. balloons 19. fake 20. ambitions
七年级英语上册课件(篇6)
教学内容:Unit 6 Do you like bananas?
教材解读
本单元主要讨论各种食物以及喜欢或不喜欢某种食物;询问某人是否喜欢某种食物及回答;会描述一日三餐,会合理搭配一日三餐。
like的一般现在时、一般疑问句及肯、否定回答;肯定句和否定句。
通过本单元的学习,认识到在平日饮食中要做到不挑食、不偏食、合理饮食。
教学目标
一、知识与技能
1.掌握基本词汇:food、banana、hamburger、tomato、broccoli、French fries、strawberry、orange、ice cream、salad。
2.掌握句型:Do you like bananas? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.二、过程与方法
通过听说读写等任务型活动,熟练应用所学单词和动词词组。
三、情感态度和价值观
认识并了解各种食物,能分清水果和蔬菜并能认识到水果和蔬菜对人体有益。通过询问对方是否喜欢某食物来引起话题。
教学重点
基本单词、词汇和句型。
教学难点
1.认识并掌握重点词汇。
2.能流利地与对方开展关于食物喜好的对话。教法导航
采用任务型教学途径并配以多媒体辅助教学,同时考虑学生的不同层次采取分层递进的教学方法。
学法导航
让学生在游戏的情景中感受到轻松愉悦、民主和谐的环境气氛,学生积极主动参与,从而产生了强烈的求知愿望,增强学习兴趣。
教学准备
PPT、关于食物的图片。教学过程
Step 1: Greetings.Greet the students as usual.Step 2: Revision Show the students pictures and ask:What’s this? It’s a soccer ball.Do you have a soccer ball? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Do you like it? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Step 3: New words Show the students some food and ask:
2What’s this? It’s a hamburger.Do you like it? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.What are these? They’re bananas.Do you like bananas? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.运用图片和对话教学单词:hamburger、banana、tomato、broccoli、French fries、strawberry、orange、ice cream、salad,并运用这些单词进行对话。
Step 4: Pair work Work in pairs and try to match the words with the pictures of 1a.Step 5: Listening 1b Listen and number the conversations.After listening, show the dialogue on the screen and get the students to practice the conversations, and then make their own conversations.Step 6: Listening Listen and circle the food you hear.First get the students to check their answers in groups and then report their answers.Step 7: Listen again Listen again and fill in the blanks.I like hamburgers.Do you like hamburgers? Yes, I do.Do you like______? No, I don’t like ______.Let’s have _______.Oh, no.I don’t like_________.Step 8: Group work Make a food survey in groups by asking: Do you like...? Then fill in the blanks to complete the form.How many students like hamburgers? How many students like bananas? Step 9: Summary Let’s sum what we have learned this class.Words:banana, hamburger, tomato, ice cream, salad, strawberry.Sentences:Do you like hamburgers? Yes, I do./No, I don’t.Step 10: Homework 1.Remember the words in this class.2.Practise the dialogue in pairs.课堂作业
1.写出下列名词
(1)汉堡 ____________(2)西红柿 _____________(3)沙拉 ____________(4)草莓 ____________(5)梨 ____________(6)牛奶 __________(7)面包 __________(8)冰激凌 _________2.根据句意完成句子
(1)A:_______ you like salad? B:No, I _______./Yes, I ______.(2)I __________(喜欢)hamburgers.(3)_____________(你喜欢)hamburgers?(4)____________(我们吃)strawberries.参考答案:
1.(1)hamburger(2)tomato(3)salad(4)strawberry(5)pear(6)milk(7)bread(8)ice cream
2.(1)Do, don’t, do(2)like(3)Do you like(4)Let’s教学反思
这节课以学生的日常生活为话题,用丰富多彩的实物和图片激发学生的学习兴趣,学生踊跃参加课堂活动,效果很好。
七年级英语上册课件(篇7)
七年级上册语文知识点教案第一课
开学第一课
欢迎大家来到崭新的语文课堂,上次我们已经接受了小初中衔接的辅导,同学们拿到这本七年级上的语文课本也有很长时间了,已经翻阅过的请举手?你们感觉初中语文和小学语文有什么不同的地方?
今天这节课,我们先不进入我们的课文学习,我们不妨先进行一场进入初中语文课堂的的欢迎仪式,或者说是语文学习的启动仪式。这场欢迎仪式将分为三个主题:一、欢迎大家来到语文大课堂;二、欢迎大家来到语文大乐园;三、确定语文学习的目标。
切入主题之前,我首先要讲一下学习上的要求:
⒈准备四本本子:
①笔记本(学习日志):每一天都记号日期,记下错题、基础字词知识、上课要求、作业要求、课堂重点内容,来不及先记书上,课后整理,课下反反复复多回顾。
②作业本③听写默写本④作文本⑤课余读书摘抄本 读书札记
⒉准备好语文学习工具书:《现代汉语词典》 《古汉语常用字字典》 商务印书馆
⒊上课要求:
①双手放桌上
②除规定的讨论朗读时间外,保持教室安静,不讲和上课内容无关的话,树立公共课堂的公共意识,上课不认真不守纪律由课代表扣分记入期末总评成绩
③主动答疑:课上完之后,都可以到办公室提出疑问。
⒋作业要求:
按时完成作业,字写端正,第二天到校立即上交小组长,没有做完的(包括听默写没有通过)中午到办公室检查,完成后回家
预习:字词摘录、课文熟读、思考课后问题
一、欢迎大家来到语文大课堂
我们看到幻灯片上特别凸显了这个“大”字,所谓海纳百川,有容乃大,语文两个字的解释是:语言和文字以及语言和文学。它有一个很大的彰显其特色的学习范围,你的视野会变得非常开阔。
初中语文的学习内容:
⒈课文:
现代诗歌、现代散文、民间传说、说明文(科学技术、经济社会)、新闻通讯、人物传记、小说节选、微型小说、文言文、古典诗词。
人物分析、语言分析、情感分析、段落分析、语义分析、自我启发和感悟
⒉语言文字基础:
现代文:注音、字形、多音字、成语、熟语、造句、词义、句型、修辞、语法、标点符号。
文言文、古诗词:文言实词、文言虚词、文言句式、通假字、古今异义
⒊写作:以记叙、抒情、议论文章为主
以上这些是我们三年系统性的学习要接触的内容,由此可见第一即是内容范围上的大,跨越古今、国别,现代性、古典性、启蒙性、社会性相杂糅。第二则是学习效用之大,小学时你们的老师肯定说过,学好语文就意味着为其他学科的审题解答奠定基础,语言文字是人类沟通交流最基本的条件,在一些思想家比如卢梭看来,语言文字认识和接受的不平等是人类不平等的起源之一,语言被划为了贵族语言和平民语言,文字只有少数人才能掌握,导致了人类的贵贱有别,而我们现代教育的语文学习即是要打破这种不平等,要每个人都掌握相同的语言文字运用才能,获得人类文明中平等的认知权、沟通权和思考权。
二、欢迎大家来到语文大乐园
下面我们来继续探讨语文学习的第二个主题,我们学习语文的概念,不仅仅局限在简单地阅读分析课文,写命题考场作文,以及反复的做题上,这是理科的学习方法。语文学习在课堂外有很大的延伸空间,这就是所谓的大乐园主题。学习应该是充满乐趣的,我们应该提倡一种快乐语文的学习方式,这些乐趣总的体现在:
⒈阅读的乐趣
上课,完成作业,只是我们看到的学习的表面,学好语文,离不开阅读大量的文字,阅读应该与我们的生活密切联系,一本课外的好书可以提前几年提升你的知识境界,可以更新你的知识含量,21世纪一份报纸一周的信息量比18世纪人类一生掌握的信息量还多。你们不用抱着学会什么的任务心态去阅读,要利用课余非学习的时间,仅仅是捧起一本书,随意的翻开,不用怕读不懂,第一遍不懂,多读几遍肯定就会有自己的理解。抄下你感到有意义的句子,当你确实有了很深的感悟想要抒发的话,写一篇读后感是水到渠成的事。
有这么一个一个故事,俄国作家契诃夫写过一篇短篇小说叫做《打赌》,讲的是一次晚会上,银行家和一个年轻的律师打赌,律师将在一间小屋里囚禁,“规定在十五年间他无权跨出门槛,看见活人,听见人声,收到信件和报纸。允许他有一样乐器,可以读书、写信、喝酒和抽烟。跟外界的联系,根据契约,他只能通过一个为此特设的小窗口进行,而且不许说话。他需要的东西,如书,乐谱,酒等等,他可以写在纸条上,要多少给多少,但只能通过窗口。”按照约定,15年后,他将得到银行家的大半财产。15年过去了,年轻人除了每天要求外界给他送书,始终没有走出过屋子一步,到达规定日期的前一天,银行家反悔了,他决定在深夜潜入屋子,杀死那个年轻律师,守住自己的财富。一根将要燃尽的蜡烛旁边,他看到已经骨瘦如柴的年轻人正熟睡着,旁边放着一封刚刚写好的信:信中说,他感谢企业家,十五年来他读了许多书,这些知识将是他终身用不尽的财富,他还明白了许多道理。他决定不再要企业家的财产,他将于明天拂晓前破窗而出,自动毁约。一起来听一下信中的一段话:
十五年来,我潜心研究人间的生活。的确,我看不见天地和人们,但在你们的书里我喝着香醇的美酒,我唱歌,在树林里追逐鹿群和野猪,和女人谈情说爱……由你们天才的诗人凭借神来之笔创造出的无数美女,轻盈得犹如臼云,夜里常常来探访我,对我小声讲述着神奇的故事,听得我神迷心醉。在你们的书里,我攀登上艾尔布鲁士和勃朗峰的顶巅,从那里观看早晨的日出,观看如血的晚霞如何染红了天空、海洋和林立的山峰。我站在那里,看到在我的上空雷电如何劈开乌云,像人蛇般游弋;我看到绿色的森林、原野、河流、湖泊、城市,听到塞王的歌唱和牧笛的吹奏;我甚至触摸过美丽的魔鬼的翅膀,它们飞来居然跟我谈论上帝……在你们的书里我也坠入过无底的深渊,我创造奇迹,行凶杀人,烧毁城市,宣扬新的宗教,征服了无数王国……
你们的书给了我智慧。不倦的人类思想千百年来所创造的一切,如今浓缩成一团,藏在我的头颅里。我知道我比你们所有的人都聪明。
我也蔑视你们的书,蔑视人间的各种幸福和智慧。一切都微不足道,转瞬即逝,虚幻莫测,不足为信,有如海市蜃楼。虽然你们骄傲、聪明而美丽,然而死亡会把你们彻底消灭,就降消灭地窖里的耗子一样,而你们的子孙后代,你们的历史,你们的不朽天才,将随着地球一起或者冻结成冰,或者烧毁。为了用行动向你们表明我蔑视你们赖以生活的一切,我放弃那两百万,虽说我曾经对它像对天堂一样梦寐以求,可是现在我蔑视它。为了放弃这一权利,我决定在规定期限之前五个小时离开这里,从而违反契约……
银行家最后放弃了杀他的打算,律师则在第二天早晨偷偷地离开了屋子。他的感悟虽然有些极端,但我们可以看到,真正的阅读是充满无限吸引力的。
你们处在中考的学习压力下,课堂语文学习会以考试做题为中心,这很容易让你们沦为考试工具,失去思想和智慧的发展潜能,为了开阔视野,我们更需要培养阅读兴趣,把读书当做信仰一般,这样,不久的将来,你们既能升入好的高中,同时也会装满丰富的思想,让自己的人生充满更多乐趣。
⒉电影、音乐的乐趣
一本好电影比我们的课文有更深的心灵震荡,一首好的歌词会有诗一样的语言,让我们获得更美的文字体验。
三、确定语文学习的目标
阅读、欣赏电影和音乐,提升的是我们的文艺素养和气质,我希望这是你们一辈子都离不开的事。但是三年,我们有一个短期的目标,每一学期的期末考,三年后的中考,要检查你掌握的知识能力,决定你能不能升入杭二、学军、杭高这样的全国名校。所以我们的学习目标是这样的:掌握良好的阅读文章能力、文字运用及写作能力;会背诵一定篇目的古诗词、文章;掌握现代文、文言文的基础字词知识。我的要求是:把我当做你们的向导,跟着我,多思考,把每一次课当做一步楼梯,一步一步的走,认认真真地上好课,做好作业,背诵好文字,持之以恒,千万不要落下。
确定课代表、组长
作业:预习第一篇课文
我的语文学习目标
我最喜欢的一本书
我期待一个什么样的语文老师
学习语文的方法
1、注重日常积累:语文考验的是自己肚中的墨水,若是自己没有一定知识累积的话,语文成绩自然不高。所以想要提升语文成绩,平时更应该注重诗词好句的积累。
2、学会理解文章:通过理清文章的结构层次,明确课文的内在逻辑,把结构层级作为记忆线索,形成知识网络,更能方便记忆。
3、学会观察周围:写作是源于生活的,最打动人的往往是细节之处。所以平时要多观察生活,写作时多做细节描写,才能真正为作文进行润色,让老师能眼前一亮。
学习语文的技巧
1、学习未动,兴趣先行
2、务学与求道
3、自信是成功的第一秘诀
4、态度决定一切
5、不强调进步
6、练就过硬的本领是学习的根本目的
7、会玩、会偷懒、然后会学
8、考试、分析考试结果、做出下一步计划、调整自己
9、学习别人
七年级英语上册课件(篇8)
牛津5B:Unit 1
《牛津小学英语5B》Unit 1 A New Term
一、教学内容
《义务教育课程标准实验教科书 牛津小学英语》5B第一单元第一教时(Part B and Part C)
二、教学目标
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词
Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Friday, Chinese, Science,
Computer Studies.
2、能正确地理解并应用句型What day is it today ?It’s…
What lessons do you have in the … We have …
3、能用所学单词、句型问答并初步感知句型Welcome back to school. Nice to see you.
三、教学重点
正确应用所学的句型问答
四、教学难点
单词的四会掌握
五、教具准备
自制课表、录音、投影
六、教学过程
A. Free talk
1.Greetings
用“Happy New Year!’’ “Welcome back to school!” “How are you?’’等日常交际用语进行问答,复习并导入新知
2.Revision
复习“I like English .What do you like?’’ “Do you like…?’’ “How about you?’’等所学句型,渗透新知
3.Present “Science,Social Science, PE, Computer Studies’’
方法:延续以上对话引出。通过实物直观呈现,在学生理解的基础上,进行单词教学(教师先范读,让生静听、模仿跟读。可通过抢答、试拼等进行巩固)为避免单词教学的枯燥,可将单词放入句型中操练,也可为新句型的教学做个铺垫。
例如: I like Science. What subject do you like? Oh you like Art. Me,too. How about you/ And you? …
师生示范一例,生生操练并问答表演。
B. Presentation and practice
1.Learn “Monday”
教师自由谈话引出,例如:Oh, someone likes PE, but someone likes English…Today is “Monday”(出示自制课表),师重复该单词,生静听、模仿跟读。延续以上对话,引出:“What lessons do we have today? ”
生听、模仿。
2.Present “What lessons do we have in the morning?”
引导学生用“We have┅”回答
1)师问,让学生熟练回答。
2)学生试问,师帮助纠正读音。
3)在会读的基础上操练并进行实际运用,师生先示范,后让学生自由练习运用。
3.Learn “Tuesday, Wednesday…Friday”
方法:渗透新句型“What day is it today? It’s…”
例如:What day is it today?
It’s Thursday.
为避免单词教法的重复,在新单词的引入时还可以用让学生试读的方法,单词的拼读可通过竞赛、游戏等方法以激发学生的兴趣。同时也可加入本课所学的句型“What lessons do we have in the morning?” “We have┅”,使对话的情景更为真实,也起到了复习的作用。
C. Practice
1)教师利用自制的课表进行连锁操练:
A:What day is it today?
B: It’s Thursday.
A: What lessons do you have in the morning?
B: We have┅
B: What day is it today?
C: It’s Friday.
….
2) 师利用投影进行有意义的操练,图文结合。
3)利用挂图,生生问答,检查表演。
D、Assign homework
1.朗诵并抄写要求会的单词、词汇和句型。
2.完成练习册A、B部分。
一、教学内容
《义务教育课程标准实验教科书 牛津小学英语》5B第一单元第二教时(Read and say 和part F)
二、教学目标
1、能正确地理解、掌握对话内容,并能朗读、初步表演对话。
2、能正确地听、说、读写单词a subject. Interesting, a week 和句型What subjects do you like ? I like…
3、能正确地运用对话中的日常交际用语Nice to see you. I hape we have more. How about you?
4、在掌握重点句型的基础上,通过本课学习培养学生的语言实际运用能力。
三、教学重点
能正确理解对话内容并能朗读和初步表演对话。
四、教学难点
能比较流畅的朗读对话,并能在掌握对话的基础上分角色表演。
五、教具准备
录音、图片、多媒体
六、教学过程
A.Revision
1.Play a game: “反口令”游戏
2.Free talk.
A: I have a … What do you have?
B:I have a …
A:I like going sopping. What do you like?
C:I like …
A:I often going shopping on Sundays. Is it Sunday today?
Ss:No,it isn’t. It’s Monday.
3.复习前一课所学有关的单词,通过图、词闪现,师生问答,或个别问答。
A: What day is it ?
B: It’s …
4. Sing a song 生初步感知、熟悉歌词及旋律。
B.Presentation
1.教学句型“What subjects do you like?” “I like…”
(由对话自然引出)T: We are having an Engilsh lesson. Do you like English?
Ss: Yes, …/No, …(师帮助学生回答)
T: What subjects do you like?(生跟读,出示板书)
S1:I like …(师作提示)
2.Teach: How about you?
师指明一名学生:How about you? 生自然地理解并作答,师可稍作提示“I like…”
3.Drill
a.师问生,直观呈观句型运用的情景,为学生自己开口说作铺垫。
b.同桌互问,要求学生适当加入问候语,真实运用语言。
c.走下坐位与学生交流,既检查学生的掌握情况,又给了学生说的场地、机会。
4.Learn “interesting”
1).教师可由以上的对话What subjects do you like? Do you like PE?生回答Yes, I do.师可引入Yes, it’s interesting.
新单词的呈现时师可放慢速度,让学生感知读音后再开口,为了使学生明确意思可在单词卡下面写出中文给学生参照。
2).Say a rhyme
根据不同的学生不同的爱好这一特点,由生描述I like …,It’s interesting .一方面训练 interesting,同时也复习前面所学各种科目的单词。师总结出rhyme.
English, English, A, B, C.
Maths, Maths, one, two, three.
Chinese, Chinese, write and read.
Art, Art, draw and sing.
PE, PE, run and swim.
C.Listen, read and say.
1.Present “I hope we have more ” “a week”
(师述引出)I like PE, do you like PE? Who like PE, please hands up. But we have only two in a week. I hope we have more.
单词week让学生多听几遍,读音可与 “need”比较读。也可提问:How many days are there in a week? 检查学生理解程度。在引入I hope we have more 后可改动课表, 如增加二节课,帮助学生理解。单词和句型的读应放在听清发音之后。
2.Listen and answer
课文对话分成两部分,降低难度,听一半对话后回答:
1).What day is it today?
2).What lessons do they have in the morning?
检查后继续听并完成句子:
What do Su Hai and Su Yang like? Su Hai likes and Su Yang likes .
3.Read the text by yourselves then together.
4.Read in roles
D. Practice
1.Look ask and answer
2.Do a survey
可借助F部分的表格,师先示范,让学生明确句型运用的场合,再相互问答。作记录后上前回答并介绍。
E.Homework
听录音,朗读并表演对话。
四人一组自编或改编对话。
一、教学内容
《义务教育课程标准实验教科书 牛津小学英语》5B第一单元第三教时(Part D, E, F and Part G, H)
二、教学目标
1.进一步掌握本单元的单词、句型达到能熟练运用的程度。
2.通过有针对性的操练,训练重点句型和难点,学生能用所学句型进行情景对话和交流。
3.了解元音字母O在开音节词中的读音。
4.能演唱本课英语歌曲。
三、教学重点
1.进一步掌握本单元的单词、句型达到能熟练运用的程度。
2、通过有针对性的操练,训练重点句型和难点,学生能用所学句型进行情景对话和交流。
四、教学难点
较熟练地掌握与运用所学句型及有关星期的单词。
五、教具准备
挂图、录音机、实物投影。
六、教学过程
A: Sing a song
1.Listen to the tape
听录音,投影歌词,学生熟悉旋律。试记歌词。
2.Sing after the tape
B: Free talk and revision
T:Good morning, class. Nice to see you.
Ss: Nice to see you.
T: I like running on Sunday morning. Do you like running?
S1:Yes, I do./ No, I don’t.
T: He likes PE, so he likes running.
What subject do you like?
S2: I like science.
T: How many science lessons do you have in a week?
S2: We have two. I hope we have more.
T: Excuse me .Do you have science today?
What day is it today?
Ss: It’s Friday.
T: What lesson do you have in the afternoon?
Ss:…
3.叫一学生走下坐位摹仿教师与其余学生交流。
4.利用挂图,操练句型 “What subject do you like ?”
I like … How about you?
I like …
先出示1幅图,师生试说后出示对话内容,其余挂图出示后生生操练再检查。
C: Look and read.
1.师引导学生读,扫除障碍,大致了解图意。
2.学习单词“trick” “minus”, 生猜其意并试读。
3.同桌问答,熟练地朗读对话。
4.你知道其中的窍门吗?用同样的方法来出题,自编对话。
例如:I like Maths very much. It’s┅
What’s 654 minus 456?
It’s ┅
D: Design a timetable
1.师出示自制的课表操练句型。
How many subject do you have this morning?
We have ┅
How many Chinese lessons do you have in a week?
We have ┅
What subject do you like?
I like┅
What lesson do you have on Wednesday?
We have┅
2. Make a new dialogue in pairs.
3. Action.
4. Design a timetable you like.
1).师示范(可利用科目粘贴的方式):选择星期几,再边问边选科目粘贴。
2)小组合作,注意用英语问答。
3)上台演示并作介绍。
S1: Today is ┅
The first lesson is┅
T: Do you have any questions to ask?
S2:What subject do you like?
S1:I like ┅
S3:Do you ┅
E: Listen and repeat.
1.利用卡片呈现单词,可加入以前所学的单词认读,如,black,happy,hat,rabbit,after,class,basketball,dance,clock,coffee,doctor,hot┅
2.同桌交流,互读,体会读音相同和不同之处。
3.Read after the tape.
4.归纳出clock, coffee, doctor,hot的共同音标,后出示图,师生共同看图说话:The hot coffee near the clock is for the doctor.
F. Homework
1.抄写本单元所学单词、词组和句型,要求能默写。
2.能熟读并会表演Read and act .
3.自由分组编演小对话。
4.调查学生的兴趣、爱好,自制合理课表。
Unit2 A telephone call (第一教时)
一、教学目标:
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词 a headache, bad , a cough ,got, a fever , a cold
2、能正确地听、说、读单词 a toothache , an earache , a backache , a stomach ache
3、能正确地理解并运用句型 What’s wrong with you? I’ve got…
4、能初步熟悉歌谣。
二、教学重点及难点:
1、能正确地朗读和书写本课时要求掌握的单词。
2、能正确地理解和运用句型What’s wrong with you? I’ve got….
三、课前准备:
1、本课所教单词的图片。
2、录音机和磁带。
四、教学过程:
A、课前热身
Game: Touch your nose/eyes/head/ear/tooth并导入back stomach
B. Free talk
T: How are you?
S: Fine thank you. /Not so good
当有学生回答Not so good 时,教师关切地询问What’s the matter?
What’s wrong with you? 并用手势引导学生回答。
(What’s the matter? 在4A出现过教师可告诉学生What’s the matter?和What’s wrong with you?的意思一样.)
板书:What’s wrong with you? 生跟读
在生回答后,师:I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.[板书,生跟读]
C. Presentation and practice.
1、Teach: toothache
a. 师与一生表演呈现
T: How are you?
S: Not so good.
T: What’s wrong with you?
S: I’ve got a toothache. (托腮作痛苦状)
T: I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.
b. 师出示图片并配以单词 a toothache
生跟读:a toothache a toothache I’ve got a toothache.(板书:I’ve got a….)
c. 练习What’s wrong with you? I’ve got a…. I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.
师问生答 生问生答
2、同法教学单词 earache backache headache stomachache
并启发学生总结此类单词的词尾特点:后缀-ache
3、学单词fever cold cough
4、听B部分录音并跟读
5、Say a rhyme
a.听录音,理解意思
b.听录音跟读
c.试着模仿改编,并朗诵.(替换high fever)
D操练句型及单词
1、整体操练
师出示图片问:What’s wrong with you?
要求生根据图片内容边做相应的动作边回答:I’ve got a……
T: I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.
2、学生两人一组自编对话并表演
3、P18 Work in pairs
a.Picture1 师生问答
b.Picture 2-6 学生两人一组看图进行模仿练习。然后分角色进行表演。
E Assign homework
1、并抄写要求四会掌握的单词和词组。
2、运用所学的词组和句型自由交谈
Unit2 (第二教时)
一、教学目标:
1.能正确地听、说、读、写单词lunch , speak, feel
2.能初步理解并运用句型How do you feel now? I feel…..
3.能正确地听、说、读日常用语M ay I speak to…?This is …speaking .See you soon
4.能熟练诵读本课的歌谣。
二、教学重点和难点:
1.能正确朗读和书写本课的单词。
2.能熟练运用本课的句型。
三、课前准备:
1.本单元单词图片
2.两部玩具电话机
3.磁带 录音机
四、教学过程:
A. Revision
师生之间以free talk的形式复习句型What’s wrong with you?和本单元B部分的单词
T: Hello xxx How are you today?(出示图片 要求学生根据图片回答)
S: Not so good.
T: What’s wrong with you?
S: I’ve got a stomach ache
T: I’m sorry to hear that. I hope you get better soon.
S: Thank you.
2.生问师答 生问生答
B. Presentation and practice.
1. 师关切地询问刚才回答不舒服的学生:How do you feel now?
帮助学生回答I feel ill/ hot /tied…
T: I can get a glass of water for you
S: Thank you.
2、板书:How do you feel now?
I feel….
I can get a/some…for you.
生跟读数遍
3、看图编对话,练习并表演(教师逐一出示P7的图片)
C Read and say.
1、复习打电话(5A学过)并新授May I speak to …
May I speak to….
T: Hello, Is that Wang Bing?
S1: Yes, this is xxx
S2: No, this is Yu Wenjie.
T: Sorry, May I speak to Yang Jie?
帮助生答Hold on, please.并把电话递给Yang Jie
Yang Jie: Hello, this is Yang Jie speaking.
(板书speak May I speak to … This is …speaking)
2学生练习用May I speak to …打电话
3在此基础上,教师出示课文挂图并用语言直接导入:Helen is not at school She’s absent today She’s ill 引导学生理解absent的意思,然后指着挂图说 Helen is in her bedroom Su Yang is calling her.让学生理解第2句中her的意思
教师出示钟面,指针显示12:30 师:Su Yang calls her after lunch.帮助学生理解after lunch
4.听课文录音回答问题
What’s wrong with Helen?
a.听录音(P14)二遍
b.指名回答问题
c. Listen and repeat.
5.学习P15对话
a.师把钟面指针拨到4:35 问:What’s the time now?
S: It’s four thirty
T: Yes Classes are over. Su Yang calls Helen after school.
b. 看图听录音
c. 帮助学生理解still take any medicine
d. Listen and repeat.
6.教师安排学生整体听录音。模仿正确的语音语调学说对话。
7.情境表演,用玩具电话设置与课文内容相仿的情境。分角色表演本课会话内容。
D. Assign homework
1.听录音,朗读并表演对话
2.根据所学的对话内容自编或改编对话。
Unit 2 (第三教时)
一、教学目标:
1.复习本单元所学的词汇
2.进一步掌握句型How do you feel now ? I feel … I can get a/some…for you . 及 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got a…
3.能正确地听、说、读、写句子 How do you feel now ? I feel … What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got …
4.能听懂、会说、会读日常交际用语 Sorry, Wrong Number
二、教学重点及难点:
能正确地听、说、读、写句子 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got a … How do you feel , now? I feel ……
三、课前准备:
1.B部分单词卡片
2.录音机和磁带
3.准备一些医生看病用的道具
4.两台玩具电话机
四、教学过程:
B、A. Say a rhyme
1.用投影片出示英文儿歌《 I’m ill 》,让学生眼看录音机朗读
2.教师逐一出示单词卡片,让学生进行替换朗读。(复习单词)
C、B. Ask and answer
1.Revesien
教师再次出示单词卡片,与学生进行问答。
T:×××,What’s wrong with you ?
S:(根据图片内容)I’ve got a …
T: I’m sorry to hear that ? How do you feel , now ?
S: I feel …
T: I can get a /some … for you .
2. Practise in groups.
a. 小组活动,让学生根据图片内容进行同桌自由问答,要求说得正确、流利。
b. 小组比赛。
D、C. Read and act
1. 教师出示这部分内容的挂图。让学生听录音整体理解对话内容。并回答问题 What’s wrong with the woman ? 从而了解学生对对话的理解。
2. 学生跟读并朗读对话。
3. 在能熟练朗读对话的基础上,让学生两人一组扮演角色扮演对话。
E、D. Work in pairs
1. 学生自由朗读这部分对话。
2. 教师指名朗读,检查学生掌握情况。
3. 模仿对话,让学生进行游戏。教师把学生分成四人小组,要求其中三人写出一个七位数的电话号码交给老师,并在号码旁注上自己的姓名。没有给出电话号码的学生要记住其中一位同学的电话号码,然后打电话给该同学。注意提示学生别人打错电话时可以说 Sorry ,wrong number .
F、E. Assign homework
1. 朗读并抄写要求四会的单词,词汇和句型。
2. 用句型 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got a … 和 How do you feel , now ? I feel … 进行笔头编对话各两组。
Unit 2 (第四课时)
一、教学目标:
1. 通过复习,要求学生能熟练地掌握本单元所学的有关疾病类词汇
2. 能熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的句型和日常交际用语
3. 能进一步掌握句型 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got … How do you feel now ? I feel …
4. 能初步了解字母O在闭音节单词中的读音
二、教学重点
能正确地听、说、读、写句型 What’s wrong with you ? 及其答语 I’ve got … 和 How do you feel , now ? 及其答语 I feel …
三、教学难点
能较熟练地掌握本单元所学的有关疾病类词汇
四、课前准备
1. 录音机和磁带,玩具电话机,医生用的一些道具,各种动物头饰
2. 单词图片
3.学生自制电话号码卡,放在桌上备用。
五、教学过程:
G、A. Free talk and revision
1. 教师一边报出一生的电话号码,一边拨打电话,该生就拿起玩具电话机和老师进行对话。
T: 722××××, Hello , may I speak to ××× ?
S: This is ××× speaking .
T: Hi , ×××, This is Miss Huang , How are you , today ?
S: I’m fine , thank you . / Not so good .
(当生答Not so good 时)T: What’s wrong with you ?
S: I’ve got a …
T: Oh , I’m sorry to hear that .
How do you feel , now ?
S: I feel …
T: I can got a / some … for you .
S: Thank you .
T: Not at all , See you soon .
(教师也可故意报错号码,让学生练习用Sorry ,wrong number )
2. 学生两人或三人一组模仿编对话并练习。
3. 小组比赛,看看哪一组表演得自然、流畅、正确。
H、B. Say a rhyme
让学生跟着录音机诵读,并练习自编儿歌。
I、C. Play a game
1. 教师创设情境:森林里有一家动物医院,里面有医术精湛的大象医生,老马医生,老虎医生和狮子医生。这两天,气温反常,许多小动物都生病了,都到医院去看医生,如果你是病人,该怎样去医院看医生呢 ?
2. 四位学生戴着大象,老马,老虎,狮子的头饰,身穿白大褂,手拿听诊器扮演医生,其他学生戴各种动物头饰扮演病人,到自己喜欢的医生处就诊。从而用 What’s wrong with you ? I’ve got a … Open your mouth and say “Ah” …等日常用语展开一段对话。
3. 教师巡视各组情况,进行及时表扬和纠正错误。
J、D. Listen and repeat
1. 教师逐个出示单词 brother , love , monkey , mother . 让学生认读
2. 让学生在多次朗读单词后找出它们的共同因素。即O发 |∧|
3. 听录音跟读句子 My mother and my brother love that fat monkey .
K、E. Assign homework
1. 抄写本单元所学的单词、词组和句型,并能默写。
2. 能够熟读并表演 Read and act 。
3. 根据实际生活情景自编对话,并表演对话。
Unit 3
一、教学内容
《牛津小学英语5B》 Unit 3 Hobbies(第一课时)
二、教学目标
1 能正确地理解、掌握对话内容,并能朗读、初步表演对话。
2 能正确地听、说、读、写单词:collect, a stamp, beautiful, a classmate, a ship, an animal。
3 能正确地运用对话中的词组和日常交际用语:take photos, Show us his stamps, please.
Here they are.
4 能正确地理解并运用句型Do you have any hobbies? Do you like…? Yes, I do.
No, I don’t. He/She likes…
5 能初步理解主语为第三人称单数时动词的变化形式。
6 初步熟悉歌曲:Hobbies。
三、教学重点
能正确理解对话内容并能朗读和初步表演对话。
四、教学难点
1 能比较流畅地朗读对话,并能在掌握对话的基础上分角色表演对话。
2 能初步理解主语为第三人称单数时动词的变化形式。
五、课前准备
1、一本有中国发行的船类和动物类邮票。
2、一架照相机。
3、Read and say 部分的投影片。
4、录音机和磁带。
六、教学过程
A Free talk
Eg: Good morning./How are you?/What day is it today?/What lessons do you have in the morning/afternoon?/What subject do you like? Do you like…?
B Presentation and practice
1 T:(出示一张印有花卉的邮票)What’s this? It’s a stamp.
Drill: stamp
T: Look at this stamp. What’s this?
Ss: It’s a flower.
T: Yes, it’s beautiful.
Drill: beautiful
2 T(出示一张印有船的邮票)Look. There’s a ship on the stamp. It’s a ship stamp.
Drill: ship
3 T:(出示几张印有动物的邮票)What’s this on the stamp?
Ss: There’s a dog on the stamp.
T: Yes, the dog is an animal. It’s an animal stamp.
(出示一张印有其他动物,如熊猫的照片,重复以上的对话)
T: They are animal stamps.
Drill: animal
4 T:(出示一本邮册)I like collecting stamps. Look, I have many stamps. They are beautiful. Do you like collecting stamps?
Ss: Yes, I do./No, I don’t.
Drill: collect/collect stamps.
5 T:(拿出一本相册)I like collecting photos.
(拿出照相机拍照)I like taking photos, too.
Drill: photo/take a photo.
Practise: The students say and do.(take a photo)
6 T:(请一男生和一女生到班前,教师指着女生对男生说)She’s your classmate.
(指全班学生)They are your classmates.
Drill: a classmate
7 Teaching of the sentence patterns.
1) T:(做游泳的动作)I like swimming. Do you like swimming?引导学生用Yes, I do./No, I don’t. I like…来回答。
2) 请一学生用I like…句型说出自己喜欢做的运动,教师逐一想全班:He/She likes…领说句型,学生跟读。
3) 教师出示Read and say部分的挂图进行句型介绍This is Yang Ling. She likes making clothes. Helen likes cooking and growing flowers.学生理解图片意思后模仿学说句型Yang Ling likes making clothes. Helen likes cooking and growing flowers.
4) 教师利用挂图进行问答练习,引出Does Yang Ling like making clothes? Yes, she does. Does Helen like taking photos? No, she doesn’t.领说句型。
C Read and say
1、The students look at the picture and listen to the tape.
2、The students listen to the tape and read after the tape.
3、The students read the dialogue themselves and the teacher gives some help.
4、The students read the dialogue in roles and act out the dialogue.
5、Ask several groups of students to act out the dialogue.
D Listen to a song: Hobbies
E Assign homework
1 Listen to the tape, read the dialogue and act out the dialogue.
2 Make a new dialogue according to the dialogue of the text.
Unit 3 (第二教时)
一、教学目标
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词a coin和词组take photos, go shopping.
2、能正确地听、说、读词组make model ships, collect stamps, collect coins, grow flowers, keep goldfish, make clothes.
3、能唱本课英文歌曲。
二、教学重点
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词a coin和词组take photos, go shopping.
2、能正确地听、说、读词组make model ships, collect stamps collect coins, grow flowers, keep goldfish, make clothes.
三、教学难点
1、能正确地听、说、读、写单词a coin 和词组take photos,go shopping.
2、能熟练运用本课所学的词组。
四、课前准备
1、画有动作的多媒体课件
2、B部分词组的动作图片和挂图
3、录音机和磁带
五、教学过程
A Free talk and motivation
1 Eg: Good morning!/How are you?/Nice to see you./Do you like…?Does he/she like…?
2 The students act out the dialogues.
3 Listen to the song: Hobbies, and sing after the song.
B Presentation
1 Present the pictures and say the phrases: take photos, make clothes, collect stamps.
2 T:(教师根据多媒体课件或动作图片提问)What’s he doing? He’s going shopping.通过教师自问自答引出make model ships, collect coins, keep goldfish,grow flowers等词组。
3 The students listen to the tape and read after the tape.
C Practice
1 把所有词组的图片贴在黑板上,教师说出一个词组并请一位学生指出黑板上相对的图片。
2 师生根据动作或图片进行问答练习,如Do you like going shopping?No,I don’t. Do you like keeping goldfish? Yes, I do.
3 教师引导学生看图,并用主语为第三人称单数的一般现在时叙述图片内容,如He likes making model ships. She likes making clothes.
4 学生同桌看图说话,自由操练词组。
D Consolidation
1 Listen and act or look and say.
(一学生发令,全班同学做动作,或一个学生演示一个动作,其他同学说出动作名称。)
2 Play the game: What’s missing?
(教师出示本单元所学的所有动词词组的图片,以最快的速度抽出一张,问学生What’s missing?学生说出被抽出图片的动词词组。)
3 Play the game: Chinese Whisper
(把学生分成小组,教师在每组第一位学生的耳边悄悄说出不同的单词或句子,让学生依次在下一位学生耳边轻声说出。然后请每组最后一位学生大声说出他/她所听到的单词或句子,说对的小组为优胜组。)
E Assign homework
1 read the phrases and copy the phrases.
2 Make some sentences with the phrases.
Unit 3 Hobbies(第三教时)
一、教学目标
1、能熟练掌握本单元所学的有关兴趣爱好词汇。
2、能熟练掌握句型Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.
3、能用句型I like…和He/She likes…,too.描述自己或他人的爱好和活动。
4、能用所学句型进行情景会话和交流。
二、教学重点
能正确地听、说、读、写句子Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.和I like…及He/She likes …,too.等句型。
三、教学难点
能正确运用Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.并能在具体情景中以口笔头或书面的形式进行交流。
四、课前准备
1、有关活动方面的多媒体课件或图片
2、录音机和磁带
3、学生自带一些有关自己兴趣爱好或活动的照片。
五、教学过程
A Sing a song
The students sing after the tape.
B Revision
1 Present the pictures of Part B with the CAI, the students say the eight phrases.
2 The teacher present the picture of Part B, the students talk about their hobbies with the sentence pattern: I like…..
3 Play a game
教师课前准备一些动作图片,一学生到讲台前挑选一种喜欢的动作图片,做图片上动作,其他学生猜他或她喜欢的活动:He/She likes …
C Ask and answer
1 Revision
Present the CAI and talk with the students.
Eg: S1: Do you have any hobbies?
T: Yes, I do. I like collecting stamps.
2 Practise in groups
1) Work in groups.
Eg: S1: Do you have any hobbies?
S2: Yes, I do. I like collecting/…
2) Compete in groups.
The students make sentences: Do you have any hobbies? Yes, I do. I like…He/She likes…,too.(The group which makes the most sentences is the winner.)
3) Make an interview.
The student interview his classmates with the topic: Hobbies.
Eg:S1: Do you have any hobbies?
S2:Yes, I do. I like making model ships/…
S1:(Point to another student) He likes making model ships, too. Right?
S2: Yes, he does./ No, he doesn’t. He likes taking photos/…
D Look,read and complete
1 The teacher present the pictures of PartD: This is a picture of Su Hai’s family. Su Hai and her family have some hobbies. The talk about the picture with the students, make the students know the meaning of the picture.
2 The students do the exercise.
3 Check the answer.
F Assign homework
1 Read and copy the words and sentences.
2 Make out a new dialogue.
Unit3 Hobbies(第四课时)
一、教学目标
1、通过复习,要求学生能熟练地掌握本单元所学的有关活动类词汇。
2、能熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的句型和日常交际用语。
3、能进一步掌握句型Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.并能用I like…和He/She likes…,too.句型描述自己或他人喜欢的爱好和多动。
4、能初步了解字母u在单词中的读音。
二、教学重点
能正确地听、说、读、写句型Do you have any hobbies?及其答语Yes,I do.和I like…及He/She likes…,too.句式。
三、教学难点
能熟练地掌握本单元所学的有关活动类词汇。
四、课前准备
1、有关活动的多媒体课件或图片
2、E部分的教学挂图
3、录音机和磁带。
4、调查表
五、教学过程
A Free talk and revision
Eg: Good morning, class./I like…Do you have any hobbies?/He/She likes …Right?
B Sing a song
The students sing after the tape.
C Do a survey
1 Present the CAI or the picture of Part B, the students say the phrases.
2 Free talk.
The students talk about hobbies with each other.
3 Do a survey.
1) The teacher do a survey as a model.
Eg: T(Present the form)Do you have any hobbies?
S1:Yes,I do. I like…
T:(Fill the form)
2)The students do the survey in groups.
4 Sum up.
教师课前做一张统计表,抽取若干组学生,让学生汇报调查情况。
Eg: T: Can you tell me about your survey?
S: Yes. Five student like taking photos. One student likes making model ships.
taking photos 5
making model ships 1
D Read and act
1 T:(Present the picture) Now ,Boys and girls. Look at the picture. What does Liu Tao like? Can you guess?
Ss:…
(The student listen to the tape.)
2 Teach the words: water, every, aunt, carefully with the picture. Learn the dialogue.
3 Answer the questions:(Make sure the students understand the dialogue)
Eg:1)What is Liu Tao doing?
2)Who likes growing flowers, too?
3)Does Liu Tao water the trees and flowers every day?
4 Read the dialogue after the tape and act out the dialogue.
E Listen and repeat.
1 Play a game:
教师用多媒体课件快速展示图片,一闪即停,然后问学生:What’s missing?让学生看图后猜单词。
2 The students read the words together.
3 Sum up the common pronunciation.
4 Present the phonetic symbol and read after the teacher.
5 Read the sentence.
F Assign homework
1 Read the dialogue of Part E and try to act out it.
2 Make a new dialogue.
3 Do the exercise of the Exercise Book.
Unit 4《牛津小学英语5B》第四单元教案
课题: Unit 4 An English friend
课时: 本单元共4课时 本课为第1课时
课时目标:1. Four skills: fast high ,Does he/she…? Yes, he does. No, he doesn’t.
2. Three skills: speak loudly, run fast, jump high, dance beautifully, walk carefully, sit quietly
3. Require the Ss to use v. and adv. properly in a certain situation
教学内容和过程:
A. Warming up
1. Sing a song.
2. Free talk
B. Preparation
1. Greetings
2. Sing a song “Come on and join into the games”
C. Presentation and practice
1. jump high
a. Now, let’s do some exercise. Sun rise. Wave your arms. Shake your body. Stand up. Jump high etc. Run fast.
b. Ask a student to jump high. (put “jump high” on the Bb)
c. Read in pairs.
2. run fast
a. Let’s act! Run fast! (Put “run fast” on the Bb.)
b. Read in pairs!
3. speak loudly
a. I say you do. fast→run loudly→speak
b. Put “speak loudly” on the Bb. and read loudly.
c. You say s. do. cry loudly sing loudly
4. Teach dance beautifully, walk carefully, sit quietly in the same way
5. Listen to the tape and read after the tape
6. Hand out the cards to some students, ask the others to guess.
7. Show Ss some photos and talk about them. Does he run fast? Yes, he does. No, he doesn’t .Ask Ss try to say “Does he …?”
8. Talk about the picture in pair.
9. Make a dialogue and act it.
D. Consolidation
Do a survey
《牛津小学英语5B》第四单元教案
课题: Unit 4 An English friend
课时: 本单元共4课时 本课为第2课时
课时目标:1. Four skills: an e-mail, busy, town, age, usually, what does she usually do? He/she usually…
2. Three skills: I’m busy, we’re the same age
3. Require the students to read and act the dialogue
教学内容和过程:
A. Free talk
B. Preparation
3. Do some exercise!
4. Talk about the photos.
C. Presentation and practice
1. What does he/she usually…? He/she usually…
a. What do you usually do? I usually play football. What does he usually do? He usually…
b. Reading and practice.
2. Look at the picture and talk about it.
c. E-mail, surf the Internet, busy
What’s Wang Bing doing? Is he surfing the Internet? He’s busy.
d. town, age
Do you live in the city? No, I’m in a small town. Are you twelve? Yes, I am. And you? I’m twelve, too. You’re in the same age.
3. Listen to the tape, answer the question.
d. Does Wang Bing’s friend live in London?
e. How old is his friend?
f. Does he usually play football?
g. Does he play well?
4. Imitate!
5. Practice in groups.
D. Consolidation
6. Act the dialogue.
7. Talk about your own friends.
《牛津小学英语5B》第四单元教案
课题: Unit 4 An English friend
课时: 本单元共4课时 本课为第3课时
课时目标:1.进一步掌握本单元所学的动词词组
2.进一步掌握句型“What does…usually do…?” “He/She usually…”
能用该句型询问他人日常生活规律
3.通过本课学习能灵活区别运用Do…? Yes,…do./No,…don’t.
Does…? Yes,…does./No,…doesn’t.
教学用具:图片 录音机 投影
教学内容和过程:
A. Say a rhyme
3. Try to read. (投影呈现)
4. Listen to the tape.
5. Let’s say together.
B. Revision
5. 图片闪现,生说本单元所学的词组
6. Introduction
T: I usually read English books and watch TV on Sundays.
My brother usually does his homework…
My parents usually…
7. Do a survey in group
S1: What do you usually…?
S2: I usually…
S1: What do…
S3: I…
8. 从他人口中了解你的同学
e.g. SA: Excuse me ,B What does C usually do…
SB: She usually…
SA: Does D…?
SB: Yes,…/No,…
9. Play a game
a. 游戏目的:复习What does…? Does…?
b. 游戏准备:师准备各类图片
c. 方法:看看,问问,猜猜
一生看图,师生共猜(个别:Does…)
C. Ask and answer
8. 出示图片,师生示范一例
9. 同桌问答
10. 扩充对话,比比哪组说得好
D. Look and read
11. Look at the pictures
12. Listen to the tape, then repeat
13. Try to say (If you are the boy)
14. Describe
Use: He goes to school…
He has…
He likes…
15. 师提供类似的图片,出示关键词,生试说(同桌),比比谁说得既流利又正确。
E. Assign homework
1. 回顾本单元所学的词组,单词,试默
2. 用所学的句型描述你同学的日常生活,兴趣爱好
提示:go to school at seven
have six lessons everyday
have lunch at 11:10
like singing
…
《牛津小学英语5B》第四单元教案
课题: Unit 4 An English friend
课时: 本单元共4课时 本课为第4课时
课时目标:1. 通过复习,要求学生能熟练地掌握本单元所学的动词词组
2. 能熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的句型及日常交际用语
3. 能进一步掌握句型Does…? Yes,…does./No,…doesnt.并能用What does …usually do…?询问他人日常生活规律
4.能初步了解字母u在单词中的读音
教学内容和过程:
A. Free talk and revision
T: I usually go shopping on Saturdays and Sundays.
Do you usually…?
S1: Yes, I do. / No, I don’t.
I usually play chess on Saturdays.
T: Does your mother work on Saturdays and Sundays?
S1: Yes, she does.
T: What does your father usually do in the evening?
S1: He usually watches TV and reads newspapers.
…
B. Say the rhymes
一生起说,齐说
C. Play a game
游戏目的:复习所学的动词词组并进行扩展,灵活运用
游戏方法:师说一副词,生做各种动作
e.g. cry /laugh/sing
You’re right. /great!
做错的:You’re wrong.
I’m sorry.
D. Read and act.
3. Look at the pictures, read after the tape in roles.
4. Change.
5. Try to ask and answer (Don’t look at your books.)
鼓励学生说,不一定要全面,完整,说一两句也行,还可以用自己的话说。
E. Listen and repeat
6. T writes some words on the blackboard or use some cards with the words.
7. Read together or ask someone to read.
3. 将单元按读音归类
[ju:] [u] [A]
4. Look at the picture, describe it then say “The puppet jumps and runs in the bus”
e.g. T: What’s this?
Ss: It’s a puppet.
T: Where is it?
Is it in the box?
Is it in the box?
Ss:…
F. Assign homework
1. 能熟练表演本课对话
2. 模仿Part A并结合重点句型自编对话(分小组进行)
Try to write a small passage (About your family member or your classmate)
Unit 5 Review and check
课时: 本单元共3课时 本课为第1课时
一.教学目标及重难点.
1. 复习及巩固动词与副词的搭配.
2. 复习问句:Does he/she…?yes, he /she does. No, he/she doesn’t.
二.教具准备:挂图,图片。
三.教学内容及过程.
Step 1.Revision
1. Greetings
2. Freetalk
1).Do you have any hobbies?
2).Do you like…?
3).Does he/she…?
4).What does he/she usually do…?
3. Answer quickly
The way: 当一个学生说出动词时,另一个学生快速的说出相应的副词.
Step 2.Look,read and write.
1. Show the pictures (1-4) and answer questions.
1).What does the girl/boy do?
2)do he/she…?
2. Read the sentences and fill in the blank.
3. Check the answers.
4. Show the pictures (5-8) and answer questions.
1).Does Miss Li like keeping goldfish?
2).Does Mr Black like making model ships?
3).Does Mrs Brown like cooking?
4).Does Mr Green like collecting stamps?
Step 3.Look and write.
1. Show the pictures of Part B.
2. Talk about the pictures.
3. Divide 8 groups and make dialogues
4. Check out.
Step 4 Consolidation
Assign homework: Finish Part A and B.
Read it and recite it.
课题: Unit 5 Review and check
课时: 本单元共3课时 本课为第2课时
一.教学目标
1. 能熟练运用“打电话”及课程的日常用语
2. 能正确掌握like + doing的形式
二. 教学重难点
目标1,2
三. 教学用具
挂图,实物,图片
四. 教学过程
Step1.Revision
1.Greetings
2.Free talk
May I speak to…?
This is …speaking.
I am sorry to hear that.
See you soon..
Sorry, wrong number.
Step 2.Look read and complete of part C
1. Show the picture and describe the dialogue
2. Make a dialogue in pairs
3. Check out
4. Play a game: Make friends
The way:做两组卡片:一组是课程名称,另一组是代表该课程的图片。
请几位学生各抽一张,并找出与自己卡片上的名称/图片相符的图片/
名称,引导学生复习课程名称,如一位学生出示代表PE的科目图片,
另一位学生则说PE。
5. Show the picture of part C2
6. Make a dialogue in pairs
7. Check out
Step nsolidation
1. Assign homework: finish part C
2. Recite it
课题: Unit 5 Review and check
课时: 本单元共3课时 本课为第3课时
教学目标
1. 通过复习,能熟练地掌握1-4单元所学的单词。
2. 能教熟练地在情景中运用1-4单元所学的句型和日常交际用语。
二. 教学重点
1. 能熟练地掌握1-4单元所学单词
2. 能综合运用1-4单元所学的句型和日常交际用语。
3. 能初步改编或扩充1-4单元所学的对话。
三. 教学难点
培养学生综合运用语言的能力。
四. 教学准备
挂图,图片
五.教学过程:
Step1. Revision
1. Greetings
2. Warming-up
3. Free talk
1) Do you have any hobbies?
2) What do you like?
I like…
3) What do you usually do?
4) What does he/she usually do?
He/she usually…
Step 2.Look and talk
1. Game “Do and Guess”
The way: 根据动作猜词组 给名词快速说词组
2. Show the picture of part D
1) 指导学生观察图片。
2)
3. According the model to make a new dialogue
4. Check out
Step nsolidation
Assign homework: Make a new dialogue and write it down.
5B. Unit 6 A部分 Read and Say
二、教学目标:
1. 四会掌握人体部位:arm , hand, foot , leg.
2. 熟练运用日常交际用语:Touch…with…
三、教学重、难点:
1. 熟练运用交际用语。
2. 灵活熟练运用日常交际用语。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和本课会话的磁带。
2. 准备本课会话的投影片。
3. 课前写好本课的课题5B. Unit 6 A部分 Read and Say
五、教学过程:
A Organization组织教学
1. Greetings
T: Good morning, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning, Miss Zhang.
2. Let’s sing a song 学生听录音跟唱英语歌曲What are you doing?
B Revision复习
1. Let’s speak English
T: What’s your name? Ss: My name is…
T: What are you doing? Ss: I’m reading…
T: Are you playing basketball? Ss: Yes, I am.
T: Does he play well? Ss: Yes, he does.
T: Does Mr. Black like making model ships? Ss: Yes, he does.
T: Does Mrs. Brown like cooking? Ss: Yes, she does.
2. Let’s act.
(1)T:创设情境,学生表演(T示范一组,运用祈使句)
T: Stand up. Jump, please… Touch your nose…
(2)学生模仿做。
C Presentation.新授
1. T又发命令作动作→人体部位名称。
2. T投影图片,由旧引新(T注音标,请学生试拼读)
3. arm, hand, leg, foot
4. 学生集体升降调朗读。
5. T指投影:T: Touch your nose with your hand.
学生理解后,T板书。
6. 学生集体朗读。
D Practice练习
1. T指投影图片,请同学快速说出人体部位。
2. 男女竞赛,争说人体部位。
3. 在熟练具体部位名称后,运用句型练习。
4. T发命令,学生作动作,练习数组。
T: Touch your foot with your hands.
5. 学生模仿教师,互相发命令。
6. Talk in pairs. 同桌发命令。
E Consolidations:
1. 请学生个别发命令,作动作。
2. T投影图片,请同学看图,填空,写出相应的单词。
3. 听录音,跟读B部分。
4. 总结:
(1) 要求同学们熟练运用日常交际用语:Touch…with…
(2)四会掌握人体部位。
六、布置作业:
1. 抄写四会单词各一行。
2. 跟读本课会话录音二十分钟。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6
arm hand leg foot
Touch…with…
The Second Period (第二课时)
一.教学内容:
5B.Unit 6 B 部分 Look, read and learn.
1. 四会单词:
time, left, right, stop, touch.
2. 四会句型:
Put…on…
Touch…with…
All right.
3. 日常交际用语:
Stand in a line.
Let’s do some exercises.
Now, listen carefully.
Jump up and down.
Do this…times…
Now, stand up, everybody!
二、教学目标:
1. 正确掌握四会单词。
2. 能正确掌握四会句型。
3. 熟练运用日常交际用语。
三、教学重、难点:
1. 正确掌握四会单词、句型。
2. 熟练运用日常交际用语。
3. 综合灵活熟练运用日常交际用语。
四. 课前准备:
1.准备录音机和本课会话的磁带。
2.准备人体各个部位的图片,准备贴在黑板上。
3.准备人体各个部位的单词卡片。
4.准备人体部位的投影片。
5.课前写好本课的课题5B.Unit 6 B 部分 Look, read and learn.
五、教学过程:
A Organization 组织教学
1.Greetings
T: Good morning/afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/afternoon, Miss Zhang.
2.Let’s sing a song.学生听录音跟读唱英语歌曲 We can dance!
B Revision 复习
1. Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss: am.
T: Is everyone here today? Ss: Yes, we are all here.
T: What do you like? Ss: I like…
T: Do you like bananas? Ss: Yes I do.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s…
T: What lessons do you have in the morning? Ss: We have…
T: What subject do you like? Ss: I like…
2.Let’s act:请两组同学站起来表演
(1)T:创设情境,学生表演(T示范一组,运用祈使句)
T: Put…on…, please… Touch your eyes…
(2)学生模仿做。
C Presentation 新授
1. T投影图片:at a PE lesson 创建情境,让学生理解 ,在一节体育课上。
T板书,学生集体朗读。
2. T创设两个情境:让学生理解。
(1)Stand in a line , please.
Put your feet together.
Jump up and down ten times.
(2)Put your hands on your head and turn left and right.
Do this ten times
D Practice 练习
1.T板书以上情境句型→四会单词 T注音,学生集体朗读。
2.学生集体朗读四会句型。
3.T发命令学生作动作。
4.Talk in pairs. 同桌互相发命令。
5.同桌互相发命令。
E Consolidations
1.男女生互相发命令
2.看投影,学生模仿录音跟读前两段
3.总结:
(1)要求四会掌握的单词:arm ,hand ,foot, leg.
(2)要求四会掌握的句型:Put…on…
Touch…with…
All right.
六、布置作业:
1.抄写句型、单词各三遍。
2.跟读本课B部分录音二十分钟。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6
time left right stop touch
Put…on… Touch…with…. All right.
5B.Unit 6 C 部分Work in pairs.
1. 四会单词:
time, left, right, stop, touch.
2. 四会句型:
Put…on…
Touch…with…
All right.
3. 日常交际用语:
Stand in a line.
Let’s do some exercises.
Now, listen carefully.
Jump up and down.
Do this…times…
Now, stand up, everybody!
二、教学目标:
掌握句型: Touch…with… All right.
三、教学重、难点:
1. 熟练运用日常交际用语。
2. 综合熟练运用日常交际用语。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和本课的磁带。
2. 准备C部分的投影片。
3. 准备本课的单词卡片。
4. 课前写好本课的课题5B.Unit6 C部分Work in pairs.
五、教学过程:
A Organizations.组织教学
1. Greetings
T: Good morning/afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/afternoon ,Miss Zhang.
2.Let’s sing a song.学生听录音跟读唱英语歌曲 We can dance!
B Revisions复习
1. Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss: I am.
T: Is everyone here today? Ss :Yes ,we are all here.
T: What do you like? Ss I like…
T: Do you like bananas? Ss: Yes, I do.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s…
T: What lessons do you have in the morning?
Ss: We have…
T: What subject do you like? Ss: I like…
2. Let’s act:请两组同学站起来表演
(1)T:创设情境,学生表演(T示范一组,运用祈使句)
T: Put…on…, please… Touch your eyes…
(2)学生模仿做。
C Presentation新授
1. 投影图片:at a PE lesson T发命令,请同学作动作。
2. 再投影另外两个情境的图片。
(1)Lie on your back. Put your knees together.
Bend your knees. Move your legs to the left, then move to the right.
(2)lift up your left leg and touch it with your right hand.
2.学生理解后,集体朗读后。
D Practice 练习
1. 发命令学生作动作,理解明白后集体朗读。
2. 个别领读。
3. Talk in pairs.
4. 学生发命令作动作。
E Consolidation
1. T投影后,整节PE课,让学生试听录音。
2. 看图片,请学生跟读录音。
3. 请学生分片段表演。
4. 总结:要求学生熟练运用日常交际用语。
六、布置作业:
1. 听录音跟读二十分钟。
2. 抄写C部分的句型两遍(两英两中)。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6
Touch…with…
All right.
The Fourth Period(第四课时)
一、教学内容:
5B.Unit 6 D 部分Look ,read and complete.
1. 掌握四会词汇:Touch…with…
2. 学习人体部分名称。
二、教学目标:
1. 正确掌握人体部位名称。
2. 熟练运用四会句型。
三、教学重、难点:
1. 正确掌握四会单词、句型。
2. 熟练运用日常交际用语。
3. 综合灵活熟练运用日常交际用语。
4. 熟练运用四会句型。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和本课的磁带。
2. 准备D部分的投影片。
3. 准备本课的单词卡片。
4. 课前写好本课的课题5B.Unit6D部分Look, read and complete.
五、教学过程
A Organization组织教学
1. Greetings
T: Good morning/afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/afternoon, Miss Zhang.
2.Let’s sing a song.学生听录音跟读唱英语歌曲 Two jackets.
B Revision 复习
1.Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss: I am.
T: Is everyone here today? Ss: Yes, we are all here.
T: What do you like? Ss: I like…
T: Do you like bananas? Ss: Yes, I do.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s…
T: What lessons do you have in the morning? Ss: We have…
T: What subject do you like? Ss: I like…
2.T投影人体图片,请学生说出部分名称
3.请学生听写四会单词
4.T创设PE课的情景,请学生分片段表演
C Practice练习
1 . 由表演→句型操练Touch…with… three times
T板书,学生集体朗读
2.投影C部分图片,学生模仿说句子
3.Talk in pairs.
4.看图写句子
E Consolidation
1. Play games Chinese Whisper
传句子:Touch your head with your hand.
2.同学之间发命令作动作。
3. 总结:要求同学门熟练运用四会句型,以及日常交际用语。
六布置作业:
1.看图写句子。
2.听二十分录音并跟读。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6 At a PE lesson
Touch…with…three time
The fifth period(第五课时)
一、教学内容:
5B.Unit 6 E,F,G,H 部分.
1. 复习人体部位名称,以及体育课上的动作词组, D.E部分
2. 复习祈使句
3. 复习现在进行时
二、教学目标:
1. 正确掌握单词,词组
2. 熟练运用祈使句
3. 综合灵活运现在进行时
三、教学重、难点:
1. 正确掌握祈使句和现在进行时。
2. 祈使句语现在进行时再正确情况下使用
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和本课唱歌的磁带。
2. 准备E,F,G,H的图片。
3. 课前写好本课的课题5B.Unit6.E,F,G,H部分。
五、教学过程:
A Organizations.组织教学
1. Greetings
T: Good morning/afternoon, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning/afternoon, Miss Zhang.
2. Let’s sing a song.学生听录音跟读唱英语歌曲 Two jackets.
B Revision复习
1. Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss: I am.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s Monday.
T: What subject do you like? Ss: I like…
T: What class are you in? Ss: I’m in Class Two.
T: What lessons do you have on Monday? Ss: We have…
2. T投影人体图片,请学生快速说出人体部位名称
3.请同学板演默写人体部位名称单词
4.T投影PE课,请同学看情景说句子。
C Practice练习
1. 请同学看情景,表演PE课内容
2. T发命令请学生作动作
3. T投影图片:D部分图片,让学生说句子作动作
4.请另外一学生运用现在进行时说出他们所做的动作
5.反复练习D部分,四幅图
6.请学生笔头完成
7.T投影E部分,请同学看图朗读;分讨论表演
六、布置作业:
1. 听录音跟读本课所内容,要求学生能够根据本课所学句子和日常交际用语进行自编会话,同桌表演。
七、板书设计:
Unit 6 At a PE lesson
D部分句型
The Sixth Period(第六课时)
一、教学内容:
第六课时是综合练习课,完成本单元学习手册。
1. F部分,活动内容。
2. 语音。
3. Sing a song.(Do some exercise with me)
二、教学目标:
1. 能听懂人体部位名称并画出。
2. 能正确听读、辨认语音。
3. 学英歌曲。
三、教学重、难点:
1.正确掌握字母组合ai、ay在单词中的发音,即[ei]
2. Listen and draw.能听懂并画出。
3 学合唱英语歌曲。
四、课前准备:
1.准备本词汇的图片。
2.准备录音机和练习册听力部分的录音。
3.黑板上预先写好课题Unit2 A telephone call.
五、教学过程:
A Say a rhyme 学生集体说歌谣,并自己配上动作。
B Free talk 师生交流。
C Revision复习
1. Let’s speak English.
T: Who’s on duty today? Ss :I am.
T: What day is it today? Ss: It’s Monday.
T: How do you feel now? Ss: I feel…
T: What’s wrong with you? Ss: I have got a fever.
2. Let’s act.
T投影PE课情景,请同学表演。
D Listen and repeat.
(1)T投影,语音. 请学生认真听然后跟读。
(2)学生集体朗读。
(3)请个别学生朗读。
E 1.T投影人体部位,请学生认人体部位名称词。
2. Listen and draw
请学生静听然后画画。
3.同桌之间互相Listen and draw
F 学唱英语歌曲。
1.先静听录音两遍,跟唱。
2.学生表演唱。
3. 总结:要求学生能听懂教师所发的命令,并能做动作。
六、布置作业:
1. 跟读录音20分钟。
2. 全面复习本单元的四会内容。
七、板书设计
Unit 6 At a PE lesson
waiter waitress day play
八、教后笔记:
通过直观教具,生动形象的动作对学生进行句型的教学,教学效果很好。人体部位名称的学习采用实物教学,学生很有兴趣。祈使句的学习采用游戏的形式对学生进行教学,让学生在玩中学到知识,由初步的感性认识再逐步上升到理性认识,最后落实到笔头,课堂教学效果很好。
Unit 7 The First Period(第一课时)
一、教学内容:
5B Unit7A部分 Read and Say
二、教学目标:
1. 能正确理解、掌握A部分会话,并能朗读、初步表演对话。
2. 能正确地运用对话中出现的日常交际用语。
3. 初步掌握会话中出现的四会单词night, half, past, a face, ready, on duty, quick, a game, a quarter, really
三、教学重、难点:
能正确理解、掌握A部分会话。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备录音机和磁带。
2. 准备投影片(早上、中午和晚上三个场景)。
3. 准备本课会话中出现的有关词汇的图片。
4. 课前在黑板上写好课题。
五、教学过程:
A Sing a song. 跟录音机边听边表演唱英文歌曲Do some exercise with me
B Free talk. 师生交流
T: Good morning, boys and girls.
Ss: Good morning.
T: Glad to see you.
Ss: Glad to see you, too.
T: Let’s play a game, OK?
Ss: OK!
C Revision.复习
1. 组织学生做“听词组、做动作”和“做动作、说词组”游戏,复习动词词组get up, have breakfast, watch TV, do homework等。
2. 在熟练掌握这些动词词组后,教师演示wash my face和brush my teeth这两个词组,让学生学习。
D Presentation and drill新授和操练
1. 教师利用教具钟以What’s the time? It’s….句型引导学生学习含有past和to的表示时间的词组。
T: (教师事先将钟拨到6:30) What’s the time?
S1: It’s six thirty.
T: Yes, it’s half past six. (教师将钟拨到6:50)What’s the time?
S2: It’s six fifty.
T: Yes, it’s ten to seven. (将钟拨到6:45) What’s the time?
S3.: It’s six forty-five.
T: Yes, it’s a quarter to seven.
2. 在学生已掌握时间表达法的基础上,教师将教具钟拨到相应的点钟并说It’s half past six. It’s time to get up.再将钟拨到6:45,问学生What time is it?引导学生回答It’s a quarter to seven.后,教师说Yes, it’s time for breakfast. Let’s have breakfast.引出What time is it? It’s time for….句型。教师示范发音,学生静听、模仿、跟读。
3. 借助挂图,解释情境,教师说It’s Thursday today. David has a lot of things to do. He’s busy. He has no rest.边摆手边装着休息状,引出单词rest。
4. 出示本部分三个场景的挂图,逐步呈现对话,让学生看图听录音,整体了解会话内容。引出、学习本部分单词、词组以及相关句型。
5. 听录音,学生模仿、跟读会话。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1. 学生小组内分角色朗读会话。
2. 学生小组汇报朗读会话。
3. 小组推荐组员到台前用所学语言描述图片内容。
4. 学生小组内看图说话。
六、布置作业:
听录音跟读本课会话,小组进行会话,准备下节课表演会话。
The Second Period(第二课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit 7 B部分 Look, read and learn
二、教学目标:
一、进一步掌握句型What time is it? It’s….
一、能正确地掌握含有past和to的时间表达法。
三、教学重、难点:
能正确地掌握含有past和to的时间表达法。
四、课前准备:
1、准备画有各种不同时间钟面的投影片
2、请各小组带一个钟。
3、在黑板上预先写好课题Unit7 After school。
五、教学过程:
A Listen to a rhyme 听本课的歌谣两遍,边听边用手打节奏。
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图进行师生会话。
2. 学生看图进行小组会话。
一、学生小组会话表演。
一、Play a game : Bingo!来复习数词。
D Presentation and drill 新授和操练
1. 出示一教具钟,教师口述What time is it? It’s….分别引出含有past和to的表示时间的词组。
2. 引导学生观察含有past和to的表示时间的词组,体会、发现past和to的用法。
3. 学生小组内练说含有past和to的表示时间的词组,使学生尽快掌握此类时间表达法。
4. 出示几点一/三刻的钟面,师生问答What time is it? It’s a quarter past/to… .引出单词quarter,强调单词中字母组合ar的发音,教师示范发音,学生静听、模仿、跟读、拼读。
5. 游戏活动:听听、指指。
教师拿出事先准备好画有各种不同时间钟面的投影片,如6:30,6:35,
6:05,教师发令,学生听音并指出正确图片。待学生比较熟练后,再请一些小助手到台前发令。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1. 游戏:抢答比赛。
以每个小组为单位进行操练,任意一成员拨一时间问What time is it?其余学生拍手进行抢答(拍手最快的学生赢得抢答权)。
2. 学生听B部分录音,跟读单词。
3. 游戏活动:听听、画画、写写。
教师口述时间,学生把它们画出来,并写出该时间。比一比,看谁画得又快又准。
六、布置作业:
1、朗读并抄写本课四会单词各一行,每行抄写单词四遍。
2、课后认认钟,用英语向家长、同学汇报时间。
The Third Period(第三课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit7 C部分 Ask and answer
二、教学目标:
1. 复习本单元所学词汇。
2. 进一步掌握句型What time is it? It’s….
3. 掌握句型It’s time for….。
三、教学重、难点:
四会掌握句型What time is it? It’s…. It’s time for….。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备C部分出现的图片。
2. 在黑板上预先写好课题Unit 7 After school。
五、教学过程:
A Listen to a rhyme 听本课的歌谣
B Free talk 师生交流
What time is it?
It’s….
C Revision 复习
1. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图进行学生会话。
2. 投影出示部分时间,让学生看图快速认读。
3. 看图学生分层次拼读本课四会单词。
4. 听写本单元部分四会单词、句型。
D Presentation and drill新授和操练
1. 运用教具钟拨不同的时间组织师生连锁问答。
T : What time is it?
S1.: It’s ten past one.
S1.: What time is it?
S2.: It’s twenty past five.
S2.: What time is it?
S3.: It’s a quarter to nine.
…
2. 教师出示C部分图片,继续组织师生问答,在学生回答What time is it? It’s….后,教师引导学生根据画面内容用It’s time for….的句型继续学说句子。教师与一个学生完整地示范第一幅图,并板书句型,后让学生模仿,分小组练说。
3. 小组学生汇报练习情况。教师抽查三到四组。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1. 分小组分别由学生自己挑选其他三幅图的内容,自由练说。
2. 各小组汇报练说结果。
3. 分小组朗读各图内容。
4. 学生摹仿、书写句型。
5. 游戏活动:“眼尖嘴快”
请全班学生闭上眼睛,让一名学生到台前拨时间,后该学生提问,全班学生回答,看谁答的又快又准确。
六、布置作业:
看图模仿教师板书内容造句。
七、板书设计:
Unit 7 After school
What time is it?
It’s…
It’s time for….
Unit7 D部分 Look and say
二、教学目标:
1. 复习本单元所学词汇。
2. 复习现在进行时句型。
3. 听懂、会说、会读并理解句型I want to….Do you want to join me?
三、教学重、难点:
四会掌握句型I want to….Do you want to join me?
四、课前准备:
1. 准备D部分出现的图片。
2. 在黑板上预先写好课题Unit 7 After school
五、教学过程:
A Listen to a rhyme and learn to say it.听本课的歌谣并学习歌谣 A clock。
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1. 出示B部分词汇图片,教师快速展示图片,学生认读并拼 读本课四会单词。
2. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图学生进行会话。
3. 投影出示不同的时间,运用句型What time is it? It’s….It’s time for….
组织师生问答。
4. 游戏活动:听听、画画、写写。
教师口述时间,学生把它们画出来,并写出该时间。比一比,看谁画得又快又准。
D Presentation and drill新授和操练
1. 教师口述示范句型I want to play cards. .Do you want to join me?让学生理解后,模仿练说。
2. 学生小组内模仿造句。
3. 小组汇报各组所造的句子。
4. 教师出示D部分图一,与一个学生示范图中会话内容:
S: I want to play cards. Do you want to join me?
T: No, I’m doing my homework.
5. 教师重复No, I’m doing my homework.通过表情、手势让学生明白该句的意思,后让学生模仿、练说。
6. 根据图片内容进行师生会话。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1. 学生分小组任意选择D部分图片内容,自编会话,进行表演。
2. 学生分小组进行汇报表演会话。
六、布置作业:
根据D部分图片内容分小组自编会话。
七、板书设计:
Unit7 After school
I want to….
Do you want to…?
No, I’m doing….
The Fifth Period(第五课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit 7 E部分 Look and read, F部分Look and guess, G部分Listen and repeat
二、教学目标:
1. 通过复习,能较熟练地掌握本单元所学的词汇。
2. 能较熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的日常交际用语和句型。
3. 听懂、会说、会读并理解E部分 Look and read。
4. 了解元音字母组合ar在单词中的读音。
5. 能熟练诵读本单元出现歌谣。
三、教学重、难点:
能正确地运用句型What time is it? It’s….It’s time for…. I want to….Do you want to…?并能在具体情景中以口、笔头形式进行交流。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备E、G部分出现的投影片。
2. 准备car, park, party, star单词卡片。
3. 在黑板上预先写好课题Unit7 After school
五、教学过程:
A Learn to say a rhyme学习歌谣 Do you like my house?
先让学生听一遍,后教师逐句领读,学生跟读。
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1. 出示B部分词汇图片,教师快速展示图片,学生认读并拼 读本课四会单词。
2. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图让学生用所学的语言知识来描述。
3. 引导学生用所学句型自编一段对话,是学生能灵活运用所学语言。
D Look and read
1. 教师出示E部分Look and read图片, 指导学生看图。
2. 教师边指导学生看图边组织师生问答What time is it? It’s a quarter to seven/eight/half past eight/twenty to twelve/ten to six/nine。
3. 看图,指导学生用所学句型描述各图。
F Look and guess
1. 游戏活动:你做我做。
请任一学生说时间,另一个学生根据时间做相应的动作,台下的学生用一般现在时第三人称单数句式完整地描述出学生所做的动作,如He washes his face at ten past six.
2. 学生根据本部分插图中的示范在小组内开展游戏活动。把学生分为三人一组,其中一个学生挂着一个设有时针的钟面,用左右手分别表示时针和分针。另一个学生做动作,让其他学生猜他们所演示的时间和动作,如She rides a bike at ten to three.
G Listen and repeat.
1. 教师出示单词卡片car, park, party, star,让学生认读。
2. 教师示范朗读单词,让学生跟读,后让学生体会单词中的共同音素。
3. 学生听录音跟读单词和句子,教师通过表情、手势让学生体会该句的意思。
六、布置作业:
听录音跟读本课所学内容,要求学生能够根据本课所学句子和日常交际用语进行自编会话,同桌表演。
The Sixth Period(第六课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit7综合练习,本课练习册
二、教学目标:
1. 通过复习,能较熟练地掌握本单元所学的词汇和句型。
2. 能较熟练地在情景中运用本单元所学的日常交际用语并能运用所学句型进行交际。
3. 能熟练完成本课的练习册。
三、教学重、难点:
1. 熟练地掌握本单元所学词汇。
2. 能综合运用本单元所学过的句型和日常交际用语。
3. 能初步改编或扩充本单元所学的对话。
四、课前准备:
1. 准备本课词汇的图片。
2. 准备录音机和练习册听力部分的录音。
3. 黑板上预先写好课题Unit 7 After school
五、教学过程:
A Say a rhyme 学生集体说歌谣,并自己配上动作。
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1. 出示A部分会话投影片,看图让学生自由交际。
2. 引导学生根据自己每天的生活情况用所学句型适当扩充进行一段对话,要求学生能灵活运用所学语言。
3. 出示B部分词汇图片,教师快速展示图片,学生个别认读并拼读本课四会单词。
4. 听写本课四会单词night, half, past, a face, ready, on duty, quick, a game, a quarter, really。
D Practice 练习
1. 听听、画画、写写。让学生先听录音,然后画出时针以表示录音中提及的时间。
2. 听听、画画、搭配。先让学生根据录音内容在空白的钟面上画正确的时间,然后将表示时间的图片与表示活动的图片配对。请一位学生在投影片上示范做,然后校对。
3. 看看、想想、写写。先请学生看图,理解其意思,然后阅读句子,最后将次序乱了的字母拼成合适的词并填入空格,以使句子完整。
4. 看看、搭配、写写。让学生先看图及句子,并根据图意和句意将图旁的字母编号写在相应句子前的格子内,然后将句子和适当的时间用线连起来,最后根据图意完成句子。让学生进行小组讨论,后各组派代表板书,完成句子,看哪组做的又快又好。
5. 读读写写。学生边看图,边读句子,然后给句子进行正确排序,组成对话。先小组讨论,后小组汇报讨论结果。
6. 看看、读读、填空。让学生试着独立完成该题。
六、布置作业:
复习本单元的词汇和交际用语。
七、板书设计:
Unit7 After school
(投影)
八、教后笔记:
本单元主要围绕David一日的起居活动学习时间表达法及问答时间的句型,教师充分利用图片、努力创设情景引导学生操练。在操练过程中,学生对时间表达法有了很好的了解,并能熟练地掌握。只有个别学生对含有past, to 的时间表达法掌握还不够牢固。
5B .Unit 8 A部分 Read and Say
二、教学目标:
1 能正确理解、掌握A部分会话,并能朗读、初步表演对话。
2 能正确地运用对话中出现的日常交际用语。
3 初步掌握会话中出现的四会单词和句型。
三、教学重、难点:
能正确理解、掌握A部分会话。
四、课前准备:
1 准备本课会话的投影片。
2 准备录音机和磁带。
3 黑板上预先写好课题 Unit 8 At the weekends
五、教学过程:
A Listen to a song 听歌曲 We know.
B Free talk 师生交流
C Revision 复习
1 出示图片,让学生看图复习以前所学的词汇---go swimming/ climbing/ jogging, play football/ basketball, play the piano/ violin, go to the park/ cinema, watch TV, play chess ...
2 活动:听听、说说、做做。学生听教师口令边说、边做动作,巩固以前所学的词汇。
D Presentation and drill 新授和操练
1 教师出示一个挂历,指着星期六和星期天问学生 What do you do on Saturdays and Sundays? 学生回答 I play football. 教师接着说:How do you spend your weekends? Oh, you often play football at the weekends.让学生理解句子的意思,然后教师指着星期六和星期天对学生说 weekend, at the weekends, 让学生理解该词的含义,跟读模仿单词weekend, at the weekends 及句型How do you spend your weekends? 板书单词及句型weekend 及句型How do you spend your weekends?
2 教师在挂历的大部分周末处画上足球,剩下的画上TV---T : How do you spend your weekends? 启发学生回答: I often play football. Sometimes I watch TV. 通过直观的图示使学生了解often 和sometimes 的含义,板书单词often 和sometimes 及句型I often play football. Sometimes I watch TV.
3 师生问答,学习并操练How do you spend your weekends?及其答语 I often ... Sometimes I ...
4 教师出示课文投影片简介课文内容,让学生了解对话的背景,然后问学生:Look. This is Wang Bing. How does he spend his weekends? He likes surfing the Internet.通过画有电脑的投影片使学生明白该句的意思。教师接着说:I likes surfing the Internet, too. I think it's very interesting. I can learn a lot from it. I can read novels、learn English、QQ, etc on the Internet. What do you think of it? 教师通过手势、表情引出单词very, learn from, 教师示范发音,学生静听、模仿、跟读,并拼读。
5 教师接着介绍课文中人物的周末活动,然后问:How does he/she spend his/ her weekends? 通过手势、表情让学生理解该句的意思,引导学生用He/ She often ... 和 Sometimes he/ she... 回答,板书学习单词sport, catch, of course
6 让学生分层次练说句型How does he/she spend his/ her weekends? He/ She often ... 和 Sometimes he/ she...
7 让学生看图、听录音,整体理解对话。
E Practice and consolidation练习和巩固
1 让学生听录音,模仿跟读。
2 学生小组分角色朗读。
3 在熟读的基础上让学生在小组内试着表演对话。
4 游戏活动:看看、说说。让一个学生做动作,其他学生用英语描述。
六 布置作业:
听本课对话的录音,要求学生跟读、读熟,并能够在小组内进行表演。
The Second Period(第二课时)
一、教学内容:
5B. Unit 8 B部分 Look, read and learn
二、教学目标:
1 通过复习能正确熟练掌握A部分会话,并能表演对话。
2 能正确地?
八年级英语上册课件十篇
以下是小编为您搜集整理的“八年级英语上册课件”。教案课件是我们老师的部分工作,因此每天老师都会按质按时去写好教案课件。教案是提高课堂教学效果的关键因素。请持续关注我们的网站以获取更多详细信息!
八年级英语上册课件 篇1
What are you doing for vacation? 学习目标: 在这一单元中,我们要学习如何谈论假期的计划(Vacation plans),对将来的安排(Future plans) 语言目标: 1. 用现在进行时表示将来。 (Present progressive as future) 2. 用where , when , what , how long 提问的句子。 主要句型: 1. What are you doing for vacation ? I’m spending time with my friends . 2. When are you going ? I’m going next week . 3. How long are you staying ? We’re staying for two weeks . Step 1. National Day is coming . We all have a long vacation about 7 days . What are you doing for vacation ? Now Let’s talk about future plans . 在这里,我们用到What are you doing for vacation ? 同学们可能会奇怪,“be doing”结构不是现在进行时吗?在这一单元中,用现在进行时代表将要发生 的动作,表示对未来的计划和安排,译为“我将要…”,“我打算…”。 eg . What’s she doing for vacation ? 她假期要做什么? She’s babysitting her sister . 她要看她妹妹。 这是我们进入初中以来第一次接触到将来时。这种用现在进行时表示将来动作的用法,实际上在英语中 是很常见的。 Now , answer my question . “What are you doing for vacation ? ” You may have lots of answers . Now , translate the following sentences into English , and choose one as your answer . Of course , you can add more activities if you like . Exercise : 1. 我要去野营。 2. 我打算看望我的姨妈。 3. 我打算在家里看电视。 4. 她要照顾她的小妹妹。 5. 他打算玩篮球。 6. 他们要在家里休息。 7. 我要去山区徒步旅行。 8. Dave准备去骑单车。 9. Mary要去旅行观光。 10. Mike准备去钓鱼。 11. Isabella要去散散步并且租些录像来看。 Keys : 1. I’m going camping . 2. I’m visiting my aunt . 3. I’m watching TV at home . 4. She’s babysitting her sister . 5. He is playing basketball (for vacation). 6. They are relaxing at home . 7. I’m going hiking in the mountains . 8. Dave is going bike riding . 9. Mary is going sightseeing . 10. Mike is going fishing . 11. Isabella is taking walks and renting videos . Step 2 . We’re going to learn other questions to ask about one’s vacation plans . 除了用“What are you doing for vacation ? ”之外,我们还要学习其它几个问句,来帮助我们更好 地谈论假期的`计划。 1. When are you going ? 你什么时候去呀? when表示对具体的时刻来提问,所以可以用on Monday ,(在星期一),on the 12th (在12号那天) nextweek (下周)、等等。 eg. I’m going the first week in June . 我将在六月份的第一周去。 2. How long are you staying ? 你要在那里呆多久? How long 是对表示持续的一段时间来提问。因此回答时,也要用表示一段时间的时间状语,而不是具 体时刻。 eg. How long is he staying ? He’s staying for a week . 他要呆一个礼拜。 或He’s staying until September . 他在那里一直到九月份。 3. Where are you going for vacation ? 你要去哪里度假? I’m going to Italy (Greece or Spain ). 我要去意大利(希腊或西班牙)。 4. What’s it like there ? 那里怎么样? 这个句型是我们在第二册中学习过的,当时我们对人提问,“What’s she like ? ”她这人怎么样。 现在是对地点对问,请你介绍一下对某地的看法与印象。 你可以回答:It’s beautiful ! It’s wonderful ! 等等。 5. How’s the weather there ? 那里的天气怎么样? 这也是上学期我们学过的句子。你可以用一系列表示天气的词来回答。 如It’s cool . (hot , humit , warm …) 6. Who are you going with ? 你准备和谁一块儿去? I’m going with my parents . 我和我父母一块儿去。 学会了上面这些句子,我们又增加了许多谈话的内容。同学们在课外,可以勤练习。 Step 3. Section B. 3a P17 1. Read the article . After reading , answer my questions . Pierre Lambert’s Vacation Plans ! Pierre Lambert , the famous French singer , is taking a long vacation this summer ! He thought about going to Greece or Spain , but finally decided on Canada . “I always take vacations in Europe , ”he said . “This time I want to do something different . I heard that Canada is beautiful , and I know there are many people there who speak French . ” Pierre is going to Canada’s Great Lakes region . He is leaving the first week in June and staying until September . He plans to have a very relaxing vacation . “I’m taking walks , going fishing , and going bike riding . I’m hoping that the beautiful countryside will help me forget all my problems . At night , I’m renting videos and sleeping a lot …a no-stress vacation ! I can’t wait . I’ll be a new man when I return to Paris ! Questions : (1)Where is Pierre going for vacation ? (2)When is he going ? (3)Why did he decide on Canada ? (4)What is he doing there ? (5)How long is he staying ? Keys : (1)Pierre is going to Canada’s Great Lakes region . (2)He is going the first week in June . (3)It is beautiful and there are many people there who speak French . (4)He’s taking walks 、 going fishing 、 going bike riding . At night , he’s renting videos and sleeping a lot . (5)He is staying until September . 二. 重点、难点: 1. Pierre Lambert , the famous French singer , is taking a long vacation this summer . 著名法国歌星皮埃尔,在这个夏季,准备度个长假。 take a (long) vacation . 去度(长)假。 2. He thought about going to Greece or Spain , but finally decided on Canada . 他考虑要去希腊或西班牙,但最终决定去加拿大。 △think about (doing)sth . 考虑(去做)某事。 eg. He often thinks about going camping . 他经常考虑去野营。 △decide on 决定(后面加名词) eg. decide on a blue coat 决定(要买)一件蓝色上衣 decide on Canada 决定(去)加拿大 3. I want to do something different . 我想做一些不寻常的事。 something 为不定代词,另外还有anything , nothing , somebody , anyone 等,都是不定代词。当 有形容词修饰这些不定代词时,切记放在这些不定代词的后面。 eg. something different 不寻常的事 somebody important 重要人物 Is there anything wrong ? 有什么不对的吗? 4. I know there are many people (who speak French ) there . 我知道,那儿有许多人讲法语。 在本句中,出现了一个重要的语法现象,定语从句。“Who speak French ”做为定语从句修饰前面的 词组many people . 许多人,什么样的人呢?说法语的人。这样,我们就很好理解了。从前,我们学过, the beautiful flower , 这里beautiful 做为定语,修饰flower , 花,什么样的花?美丽的花。当单个 的词做定语,一般放在名词的前面,(注:修饰不定代词时需放在后边),而当一个句子做定语时,一般要 放在被修饰词的后面,这个句子则被称为定语从句。 eg . I’m waiting for that man (who is in black . ) 我正在等那个穿黑衣服的人。 5. Canada’s Great Lakes region . 加拿大的五大湖地区。(加拿大与美国之间的五个大湖, 景色怡人,风景秀丽。) 6. He plans to have a very relaxing vacation . △plan to do sth . 计划去做某事,to后面加动词原形。 eg. My classmates plan to go to a picnic . 我的同学们计划去野餐。 △have a very relaxing vacation . 过一个非常惬意的假期。 另外,have a good time 过得很愉快。 7. I’m hoping (that the beautiful countryside will help me forget all my problems . ) 我希望美丽的风光能帮我忘记一切烦恼。 △在本句中,that引导的一整句话,都做为谓语hope的宾语,被称为宾语从句。这一整句都是“我所希 望的事”。that只是宾语从句的引导词,没有实际含义。 eg. The teacher said that some students left school at 5:30 yesterday . 老师说,昨天有些同学五点半才离校。 help sb do sth . 帮助某人做某事。 在Unit 1 中,我们学过“help me to study more”这
八年级英语上册课件 篇2
Teaching Plan For Unit 1
Teaching Materials & Analysis Contents Warming Up P1
Pre-reading P1
Reading P1-2
Comprehending P2
Learning about Language
Discovering useful words & expressions
Discovering useful structures P3-4
Using Language Listening & speaking P5-8
Reading, speaking & writing
Summing up
Workbook & Test P41-47
Importance 1. Have students learn some useful new words and expressions and let them learn effective ways to remember English vocabulary.
2. Get students to learn about the history of the Amber Room and famous cultural relics in China and abroad to stimulate their sense of cultural relics protection.
3. Enable students to learn to tell the difference between facts and opinions to train their thinking and analyzing ability.
4. Let students learn to give opinions and ask for opinions in English.
5. Let students learn the. new grammar item:the restrictive attributive clause and non-restrictive attributive clause.
6. Develop students’listening,speaking,reading and writing ability
Difficulties 1. Train students' thinking and analyzing ability by making them learn to tell from facts and opinions.
2. Develop students’ speaking ability by encouraging them to give opinions and ask for opinions in English.
3. Develop students’integrated skills.
Teaching Aims Topic cultural relics protection;
famous cultural relics in China and abroad
Vocabulary Words race,valuable,survive,vast,dynasty,amaze,amazing,select,honey,design,fancy,style,decorate,jewel,artist, belong,troop,reception,remove,wooden,doubt,former,worth,local,apart,painting,castle,trial,evidence,explode,entrance,sailor,sink,maid,informal,debate
Expressions in search of,belong to,in return,at war,less than,take apart,think highly of
Functional Items 1)Asking for opinions
2)Giving opinions
Structures the attributive clause
Arrangement
of time 1st Warming Up Pre-reading Reading Comprehending
2nd Language points
3rd Grammar
4th Using Language: Reading & talking
5th Using Language: Listening & speaking
6th Using Language: Reading & writing 1)Asking for opinions
7th Revision
1)Asking for opinions
The 1st Period
Unit 1 Contents Warming Up Pre-reading Reading Comprehending
Teaching Aims Knowledge Vocabulary words rare,valuable,survive,vase,dynasty,amaze,select,honey,design,fancy,style,decorate,jewel,artist,belong,troop,reception,remove,wooden,doubt,former,worth
phrases in search of,be long to,in return,at war,less than
1. Get students to learn the useful new words and expressions in this part.
2. Let students learn about the history of the Amber Room.
Ability 1. Let students read the passage In Search of the Amber Room to develop their reading ability.
2. Enable students to learn to talk about cultural relics.
Emotion 1. Stimulate students’sense of cultural relic`s protection by reading the passage In Search of the Amber Room.
2. Develop students’sense of cooperative learning.
Analysis
of the teaching materials Importance 1. Let students read the passage In Search of the Amber Room and learn about the history of the Amber Room.
2. Get students to learn different reading skills.
Difficulties 1. Develop students’reading ability.
2. Enable students to learn to talk about cultural relics.
Multimedia Computer PPT CD
Teaching & Learning methods 1. Task-based Teaching & Learning
2. Cooperative learning
3. Discussion
Teaching Procedures
The 1st Period
Step 1 Warming up
1. Warming up by looking and talking
2. Give students 4 minutes to read the passage carefully,and do Exercise 1 and Exercise 2 in Comprehending on page 2.
3. Listening and reading aloud
Play the tape of the text for students to listen to and follow. Then ask them to read the text aloud.
4. Deal with some new words,expressions and structures.
5. Discussion of style. Let students discuss the following questions:,
How does this passage present facts about the Amber Room? Can you find the opinions?
What is the author's attitude towards the Amber Room? How do you know?
Step 2 Pre- reading
Turn to page 1 and finish Pre- reading part.
Step 3 Reading
1. Skimming for the general idea of each paragraph
Ask students to read the passage fast to get the key words and general idea of each paragraph and fill in the chart.
The general ideas
Paragraph The History of the Amber Room
1
2
3
4
5
2. Scanning for detailed information
Ask students to read the passage carefully to locate the detailed information.
Do Exercise 1 and Exercise 2 in Comprehending on page 2.
3. Deal with any language problems students might meet while checking the
answers with the whole class.
4. Reading aloud and underlining
Ask students to read the passage aloud to the tape and let them pay attention to the pronunciation of each word and the pauses within each sentence. Tell them to pick out all the useful expressions or collocations from the passage while reading and copy them to the notebooks after class as homework.
be used to do..., be made into, make the design for the room,
feel as hard, as stone, be of the fancy style,
give the name, be made into any shape, be made with gold and jewels, in fact, as a gift of, in return,
be made to be a gift, serve as, add more details to...,
the search for, be made for, one of the great wonders,
art objects, look much like, at war,
remove... from., remain a mystery, be ready for…
Step 4 Consolidation
Go over the key words with the students and write them on the blackboard. Give students 3 minutes to prepare and then ask some to retell the story of the Amber Room to the class.
Step 5 Closing down by having a discussion
Raise the following questions and discuss them with the students.
Can you imagine the fate of the Amber Room? What is it?
Do you think if it is worthwhile to reproduce the Amber Room? Why?
Step 6 Homework
1. Learn the useful new words and expressions in this part by heart.
2. Read the text again and try to talk about the history of the Amber Room.
The 2nd Period
Unit 1 Contents Reading Comprehending & Learning about language
Teaching Aims Knowledge Vocabulary words rare,valuable,survive,vase,dynasty,amaze,select,honey,design,fancy,style,decorate,jewel, artist,belong,troop,reception,remove,wooden,doubt,former,worth
phrases in search of,belong to,in return,at war,less than
1. Get students to learn and grasp the important useful new words and expressions in this part
2. Let students learn some important and useful sentence patterns
Ability 1. Get students to use some useful new words and expressions correctly.
2. Enable students to make sentences after the useful sentence patterns.
Emotion 1. Stimulate students' interest in learning English.
2. Develop students’ spirits of cooperation and teamwork.
Analysis
of the teaching materials Importance 1. Enable students to grasp the usages of such important new words and expressions as survive,belong,doubt,belong to,in search of,etc.
2. Get students to master the patterns:“Sadly,although the Amber Room was considered one of the wonders of the world,it is now missing,and“There is no doubt that the boxes were then put on a train for Konigsberg.. .”
Difficulties 1.Let students learn the usages of the words“belong“ and“doubt”and the expression ”belong to".
2.Get students to understand some difficult and long sentences.
Multimedia Computer PPT CD
Teaching & Learning methods 1. Task-based Teaching & Learning
2. Cooperative learning
3. Discussion
Teaching Procedures
The 2nd Period
Learning about important language points
Step 1 Revision
1. Check the homework exercises.
2. Ask some students to tell the history of the Amber Room.
Step 2 Reading and finding
Get students to read through Warming Up,Pre-reading,Reading and Comprehending to underline all the new words and useful expressions or collocations in these parts.
a cultural relic,be rare. and valuable,survive for a long time,whether... or not,an amazing history,be used to do...,the design of the room,the fancy style,popular in those days,give the name,decorated with gold and jewels,in fact,as a gift of...,in return,be made to be a gift,serve as,add more details to,the search for,be made for, one of the wonders,art objects,look much like...,at war,remove... from...,remain a mystery,be ready for.
Read them aloud and copy them down in the exercise book after class.
Step 3 Practice for useful words and expressions
1. Turn to page 3. Go through the exercises in Discovering useful words and expressions with students and make sure they know what to do.
2. Give them several minutes to finish the exercises. They first do them individually,and then discuss and check them with their partners.
3. Check the answers with the whole class and explain the problems they meet where necessary.
Step 4 Vocabulary study
1. survive vt. & vi。
1)vi. continue to live or exist继续生存或存在
Few survived after the flood. 洪水后生还者极少。
The custom still survives. 这种风俗习惯还保存着。
2)vt. continue to live or exist in spite of nearly being killed or destroyed
幸存;幸免于
He survived the shipwreck. 在这次船只沉没事件中他幸免于难。
The plants may not survive the frost. 这些植物不经冻。
The house survived the storm. 经过暴风雨袭击,这所房屋并未倒塌。
3)vt. remain alive after sb.比某人长命
He survived his wife for many years. 他比妻子多活好多年。
【拓展】
survivor,person or thing that has survived幸存者;逃生者;残存物
survival n. 1)state of continuing to live or exist幸存;残存;生存
2) person, thing, custom,belief, etc. that has survived from an earlier time 遗老;遗习;旧风俗;旧思想
2. belong to: be the property of; be a member of 属于;是…的成员
The land belongs legally to the government. 该地依法属政府所有。
The blue sky belongs equally to us all. 蓝天为我们所共有。
They belonged to a younger generation. 他们属于年轻的一代。
【注意】
belong to不用于被动语态,也不用于进行时态。例如:
这本书现在属于我。
正:This book belongs to me.
误:This book is belonged to me.
误:This book is belonging to me.
3. in return: as payment or a reward for sth. 作为对某事的酬谢或回报
I bought him a drink in return for his help.我请他喝酒以酬谢他的帮助。
He presented her a notebook in return. 他回赠给她一本笔记本。
4. doubt n. & v.uncertainty or disbelief; reason for not believing sth.
怀疑;不确定;不信任;不相信
There is not much doubt about it. 这没什么可怀疑的。
I have doubts about his competence. 我对他的能力有很大怀疑。
He has his doubt to this being true. 他怀疑这件事是否属实。
Please dismiss all doubts about it. 怀疑是人的天性。
I do not doubt of your success. 我不怀疑你的成功。
I doubt whether/if he is at home. 我看他不一定在家.
I do not doubt that he can recite it. 我相信他能把它背下来。
Can you doubt that he will win? 你不相信他会获胜吗?
I doubt what he said. 我不相信他说的话。
5.remain vi. usually not used the continuous tenses通常不用于进行时态
1)be left or still present after other parts have been removed or used or dealt with剩下;剩余)
After the fire,very little remained of my house. 火灾过后,寒舍所剩无几。
If you take 3 from 8,5 remains. 8减3剩5。
2)be left to be seen, done, said, etc. 留待以后去看、去做、去说等
It remains to be seen whether you are right. 你是否正确,以后可见分晓。
Much remains to be done. 要做的事情还很多。.
3) stay in the same place;stay behind停留,逗留;留下
I remained in London until May. 我在伦教一直待到五月.
She left,but I remained(behind). 她走了,我没走。
4) continue to be;stay in the same condition仍然是;保持不变
We should remain modest and prudent. 我们应该保持谦虚谨慎。
Let things remain as they are. 保持现状吧.
【辨析]remain&stay
remain和stay都指“继续停留”或“继续保持某种状态、关系或行动”,二者常可互换。
remain强询“继续停留于一处或保持原状态,情况性质不改变”。例如:
This place remains cool all summer. 这个地方整个夏天都凉爽。
stay强调“某人或某物继续留在原地而不离开”。例如:
He stayed to see the end of the game. 他一直待到比赛结束。
Step 5 Sentence focus
1. This gift was the Amber Room,which was given this name because several tons of amber were used to make it.
这件礼物就是唬拍屋,它之所以有这个名字;是因为造这间房子用了好几吨珑拍.
这是一个复合句,句中which was given this name because several tons of amber were used to make it为非限制性定语从句,从句中又含有原因状语从句because several tons of amber were used to make it。
非限制性定语从句,修饰物时用which, whose;修饰人时用who, whom, whose。非限制性定语从句和它的先行词之间只是松散的关系,往往是对先行词作补充说明,这种从句在朗读时有停顿,在文字中通常有逗号与主句隔开。例如:
The chairman,who spoke first,sat on my right.
主席坐在我的右边,他最先发言。
The speech,which bored everyone,went on and on.
那演讲一直在进行,大家都觉得厌烦。
关系副词where和when也能引导非限制性定语从句。例如:
On April 1 they flew to Beijing,where they stayed several days.
4月1日他们飞到北京,在那里待了几天。
I'm seeing the manager tomorrow,when he will be back from New York.
我明天要去见经理,他明天从纽约回来。
另外,由which引导的非限制性定语从句,有时候修饰整个句子或句子中的某个部分。例如:
They have invited us to visit their country,which is very kind of them.
他们非常友好地邀请我们去访问他们的国家。
They usually take a walk after supper,which does them a lot of good.
他们通常晚饭后去散步,这么做对他们很有好处。
2. The design of the room was in the fancy style popular in those days.
屋子的设计是当时流行的极富艺术表现力的建筑式样。
这是一个“主系表”结构的句子,in the fancy style...在句子中用作表语,注意介词in的用法,此处表示“以……方式,以……式样,以……风格”。类似用法有in a different way等。
popular in those days是形容词短语修饰the fancy style,形容词词组作定语时,通常都作后置定语。例如:
They have a house larger than yours. 他们的房子比你的大.
The boys easiest to teach are in my class. 我班上的男生最好教了。
嵌这类后置的定语在意义上相当于定语从句。例如:
a house larger than yours= a house which is larger than yours
the boys easiest to teach=the boys who are easiest to teach
3. In 1770 the room was completed the way she wanted.
1770年,这间唬拍屋按照她的要求完成了。
句子中的the way she wanted作状语,表示方式。此句实际为the room was
completed the way she wanted it to be completed, the way表示“方式;方法”,在定语从句中作状语时,后面的从句的引导词常常用that或in which或省略。例如:
I was never allowed to do things the way I wanted.
我从来就不被允许按照自己的想法去做事情。
We have to make it work in the way(that/in which) they want it to.
我们必须按照他们的想法把事情办好。(此句中way在从句中作状语)
He was looking at her in the way that surprised her.
他看着她的样子让她很惊讶。(注意此句中that可用which替换way在定语从句中作主语)
4. There is no doubt that the boxes were then put on a train for Konigsberg,which was at that time a German city on the Baltic Sea.
毫无疑间,这些箱子后来被装上火车运往哥尼斯堡,当时它是波罗的海边的一个德国城市。
这是一个复合句,that the boxes were then put on a train for Konigsberg是同位语从句,表示与之同位的doubt的实际内容。which was at that time a German city on the Baltic Sea是Konigsberg的非限制性定语从句,先行词为Konigsbergo
同位语从句常用that来引导,但随着与其同位的名词不同,也可由when, where,whether, how等来引导。例如:
They had to face the fact that the nearest filling station is thirty kilometers away. 他们不得不面对这样一个现实:最近的加油站还在30千米外。
The doctors came to the conclusion that the patient was suffering from cancer. 医生们作出了诊断结果:病人身患癌症。
I have no idea when he will return.我不知道他何时回来。
* There is no doubt that...可作为固定句型来用,意思是“毫无疑间……”。例如:
There is no doubt that he is a fine scholar.
毫无疑问他是一位优秀的学者。
There is no doubt that you can find a way to solve this problem.
毫无疑问你能找到解决这个问题的办法.
Step 6 Using words and expressions
Turn to page 42. Ask students to do the exercises in Using words and expressions in the Workbook. The following procedures may be followed:
1. Go through the two exercises with students and make sure they know what to do.
2. Several minutes for students to finish them individually.
3. Check the answers with the whole class.
Step 7 Homework
1. Finish off the Workbook exercises. Do Exercise 3 in your exercise book.
2. Learn the useful new words and expressions by heart.
The 3rd Period
Unit 1 Contents Learning about language
Teaching Aims Knowledge Vocabulary words local
phrases
1.Get students to know the structures of the restrictive and non-restrictive attributive clauses.
2. Let students learn the usages of the restrictive and non-restrictive attributive clauses.
Ability Enable students to use the restrictive and non-restrictive attributive clauses correctly and properly.
Emotion l. Get Ss to become interested in grammar learning.
2. Develop Ss' sense of group cooperation.
Analysis
of the teaching materials Importance 1. Get students to master the structures and usages of the restrictive and non-restrictive attributive clauses.
2. Let students know the differences between the restrictive attributive clause and non-restrictive attributive clause.
Difficulties Enable students to learn how to use the restrictive and non-restrictive attributive clauses correctly.
Multimedia Computer PPT
Teaching & Learning methods 1. Task-based Teaching & Learning
2. Cooperative learning & Practice
Teaching Procedures
Step 1 Revision
1. Check the homework exercises.
2. Dictate some important sentences in the passage In Search o f the Amber Room.
Step 2 Grammar revision
Ask students to review relative pronouns and relative adverbs and then do some related exercises.
Step 3 Learning about grammar
1. Let students pick out the sentences that use the attributive clauses from Warming up,Pre-reading and Reading,read them aloud and then translate them into English.
2. Ask students to study these sentences,and compare the sentence“This gift was he Amber Room,which was given this name because almost several tons of amber were used to make it with the others. Let them try to find the difference.
3. Sum up:Restrictive & non-restrictive clauses.
Do the following pair of sentences mean the same thing?
My uncle,who lives in London,is very rich.
My uncle who lives in London is very rich.
The first sentence has a non-restrictive clause within two commas,and the second has a restrictive clause. A non-restrictive clause simply adds more information into the sentence and does not affect the meaning of the main clause;it is therefore bracketed off with commas. Conversely,a restrictive clause defines its referent in the main clause more specifically and contributes significantly to the meaning of the sentence.
Step 4 Grammar practice
1. Let students finish Exercise 3 and Exercise 4 in Discovering useful structures on page 4 and exercises in Using Structures on page 43.
2. Check the answers with the whole class,and see how well the students did.
Step 5 Additional exercises
Provide some exercises for students to test whether they have grasped the restrictive & non-restrictive attributive clauses.
Step 6 Homework
1. Finish off the workbook exercises. Do the exercises in Using Structures in your exercise book.
2. Preview the next part Using language.
The 4th Period
Unit 1 Contents Using language: Reading & Talking
Teaching Aims Knowledge Vocabulary words trial,consider,opinion,evidence,prove,pretend
phrases more than,even though
1. Get students to learn some useful new words and expressions in this part
2. Let students know what a fact is,what an opinion is and the difference between them.
Ability 1. Develop students’reading skills by extensive reading and enable them to learn how to use different reading skills to read different reading materials.
2. Train students’ speaking ability and enable them to tell the difference between facts and opinions and talk about something which interests them and about something which they are familiar with.
Emotion 1. Enable students to learn from Feng Jicai and protect cultural relics in their home town or city.
2. Develop students' sense of group cooperation and teamwork.
Analysis
of the teaching materials Importance 1. Develop students’reading skills by extensive reading.
2. Train students' speaking ability by telling the difference between fact and opinion and talking about something which interests them and about which they are familiar with.
Difficulties 1. Enable students to learn to use reading strategies such as skimming and scanning.
2. Get Ss tolearn how to tell facts from opinions.
Multimedia Computer PPT
Teaching & Learning methods 1. Task-based Teaching & Learning
2. Cooperative learning & Practice
3. Discussing
Teaching Procedures
The 4th Period
Step 1 Revision
1. Check the homework exercises.
2. Ask students to translate some sentences using the attributive clause.
Step 2 Warming up by discussing
Tell students:We are going to read a passage about fact,opinion and evidence. Before reading it,let`s discuss the following questions.
1. If you want to go in for law against somebody,and if you want to win,what`s the most important thing, you should do first?
2. What makes a judge decide which eyewitnesses to believe and which not to believe?
Step 3 Reading
1. Ask students to turn to page 5.
2. Two minutes for students to read the passage fast and try to get the main idea.
3. Four minutes for students to read the passage again and answer the questions.
What is a fact?
What is an opinion?
What is evidence?
4. Ask students to listen to the tape and read the passage aloud.
5. Photocopy a brief newspaper article,preferably one which talks about. a crime trial. Then have students pick out the facts and opinions and give reasons for their answers.
Step 4 Talking
1. Ask students to turn to page 41 and make a dialogue giving facts and opinions.
2. Let them check and practice the dialogue in pairs and then give a performance for the class.
Step 5 Reading task
1. Show students Feng Jicai`s photo and one of his novels and talk about them.
2. Ask students to turn to page 45,read the passage Big Feng to the Rescue to try to find the best summary and answer these questions.
3. Let students discuss:How can we do to help Feng Jicai with his projects?
Step 6 Summing up
Ask students to choose one of the following to prepare and then report to the class.
1. Tell the differences between facts and opinions.
2. Tell something about how Feng Jicai protected the cultural relics of his hometown.
3. Talk about something which interests you in your own life.
Step 7 Homework
1. Finish off the Workbook exercises.
2. Read the two passages again and try to grasp the main idea of them.
The 5th Period
Unit 1 Contents Using language: listening & speaking
Teaching Aims Knowledge 1. Get students to learn some useful new words and expressions in this unit.
2. Let students learn the expressions of asking for opinions and giving opinions.
Are you sure he/she was telling the truth? How do you know that?
How can you be sure he/she was telling the truth?
Why/Why not?
I don't believe...,because...
That can't be true. It is(not) a fact.
I (don't) agree with you. I don't agree that..,
It can be proved. The truth is (not) easy to know.
I think they have said useful things.…has no reason to lie.
Ability 1. Enable students to catch and understand the listening materials.
2. Develop students’ability to get special information and take notes while listening.
3. Get students to learn how to ask for opinions and give opinions.
4. Let students write a short report.
Emotion 1. Enable students to know more about cultural relics and stimulate their sense of protecting cultural relics.
2. Develop students’sense of group cooperation and teamwork.
Analysis
of the teaching materials Importance 1. Develop students' listening and speaking abilities.
2. Enable students to master different listening skills.
3. Let the students learn how to ask for opinions and give opinions.
Difficulties 1. Get students to listen and understand different listening materials.
2. Develop students’speaking ability.
Multimedia Computer PPT
Teaching & Learning methods 1. Task-based Teaching & Learning
2. Cooperative learning
3. Discussing
Teaching Procedures
The 5th Period
Step 1 Revision
1. Check the homework exercises.
2. Ask some students to talk about facts,opinions and evidence.
Step 2 Warming up by talking
Ask students to talk about the story of the Amber Room and its fate. Tell the students:
No one knows exactly what happened to the Amber Room. A few people say that they were eyewitnesses who saw where the Amber Room was hidden. Listen to their stories. .-
Step 3 Listening on pages 5-6
Turn to page 6.Ask students to look at the two forms and listen to the tape,take notes of what they hear and fill in the forms.
Step 4 Speaking on page 6
Turn to page 6.Ask students to share their forms with a partner,discuss together which person gave the best evidence,write down a short list of reasons for their choice and then give a short report about their list to the class.
Step 5 Listening on page 41
Ask students to turn to page 41,look at the picture and talk about the Aswan Dam and Abu Simbel temple. Let them listen to the tape and answer the questions and then check the answers with the class.
Step 6 Listening task on page 44
1. Ask students to look at the picture on page 44 and describe it. Then play the tape for students to listen to and get the main idea of the listening text.
2. Let students listen again and fill in the chart with details.
3. Ask students to listen to the tape a third time and try to get the right answers.
Step 7 Consolidation
Show students the three listening texts,let them read the texts aloud and then retell them.
Step 8 Homework
1. Finish off the Workbook exercises.
2. Read the listening texts again and try to retell them.
The 6th Period
Unit 1 Contents Using language: Reading & speaking
Teaching Aims Knowledge Vocabulary words treasure,besides
phrases search for,think highly of
1. 1. Get students to learn and master the new words and useful expressions:
2. Let students know the form of an English letter.
Ability 1. Develop students’writing ability by writing letters.
2. Enable students to express agreement and disagreement.
3. Enable students to express good reasoning and strong feelings.
Emotion 1. Stimulate students’sense of cultural relic's protection and encourage them to persuade others to protect cultural relics.
2. Enable students to master writing skills and write excellent letters.
Analysis
of the teaching materials Importance 1. Develop students’writing ability.
2. Get students to use the expressions of expressing agreement and disagreement,and reasoning.
Difficulties 1. Get students to learn to express good reasoning and strong feelings.
2. Let students learn how to write a persuasive letter.
Multimedia Computer PPT
Teaching & Learning methods 1. Task-based Teaching & Learning
2. Cooperative learning
3. Discussing
Teaching Procedures
The 6th Period
Step 1 Revision
1. Check the homework exercises.
2. Ask students to dictate the new words and expressions:treasure,besides,think highly of,tell the truth,etc.
Step 2 Warming up
Ask students to talk about cultural relics found in their daily life. Ask them what they would do if they found a rare cultural relic.
Step 3 Reading
Let students read the letter and answer some questions according to the letter.
Step 4 Writing
Ask students to have a class debate and write a report on their debate.
Step 5 Writing task
Suppose there is one cultural relic in your hometown that is worth saving or protecting. Write a letter to all the students of your school to encourage them to help save the cultural relic.
1. Let students read the outline as a guide.
2. Give 10 minutes to them to write the letter.
3. Ask as many students as possible to read their letters to the class.
Step 6 Homework
1. Finish off the Workbook exercises.
2. Write the two letters in your exercise book.
八年级英语上册课件 篇3
1.了解通讯的基本特点。
1.培养学生搜集、筛选和整理信息的能力。
2.学习叙述、议论、抒情相结合的写法,培养阅读和写作的能力。
1.了解中队的发展情况及实力,培养学生的集体主义精神和爱国情感。
1.了解通讯的文体特征。
2.掌握本文围绕中心精心选材、巧妙组材的特点。
要保证我们祖国和人民的利益不受侵犯,就必须取大家之智慧,集大家之所长,以提高我国综合国力为目标,实现民族复兴。俗话说的好,国不可一日无“军”。国家要强盛,必须要有一个强大的军队。航母建设承载国人百年强国强军梦想,而只有舰载战斗机成功着舰起飞,中国首艘航空母舰——辽宁舰才是真正意义上的航母。让我们走进“我国航母舰载战斗机首架次成功着舰”的现场,去领略一下我们这支精锐军队的风采,去见证让人激动、自豪的“圆梦”时刻吧!
获悉我国将首次组织航母舰载战斗机着舰起飞的消息后,记者多方协调,随直升机飞降正在海上训练的辽宁舰,从高空中目睹了“航母就像汪洋中一片树叶”。现场采访中,记者获取了进入采访部位——辽宁舰岛塔台采访的机会,充分利用这个视角,全过程见证我国舰载战斗机首次着舰起飞。
娴熟:老练、熟练或灵活,形容对某种事物或工作很熟练。
定格:电影、电视片的活动画面突然停止在某一个画面上。文中指当时的相机记录下的场面。
1.教师范读,学生听读,在课文上标注生字词读音。
2.学生自读,了解课文大意,梳理文章结构。
介绍歼-15舰载机着舰前的准备,点明此项任务的危险。
描绘歼-15舰载机着舰的过程。
1.文章开头为什么描写渤海某海域海上恶劣的环境?
描写海风之大和海浪之汹涌,为下文舰载机着舰设置了集体环境,突出此时着舰之险,衬托了我国着舰技术的成熟。
2.文中引用着舰遇难事故数据有什么作用?
揭示我国航母舰载机首次着舰的意义——它承载着国人和海军官兵强军的梦想,交代舰载战斗机着舰是世界公认的风险的难题。渲染出紧张的氛围,引发读者的关注和继续阅读的兴趣,为下文写舰载机成功着舰后人们的喜悦作铺垫。
3.文章写着舰过程中,用具体时间显示进程,这样写有必要吗?
有必要。以时间为序更体现事件的紧迫性,给读者以真实感,给人一种身临其境的感觉。
4.这篇通讯在描写战机着舰过程时多次描写了四周人的神态和心情,简明扼要分析作者这样写的用意。
提示:战机着舰是这篇通讯的主要事件,而人们的神态和心情是辅助之笔,用以从侧面表现主题。要从气氛的烘托上、现场感的营造上、主题的突出上等角度综合分析其用意。表现人们对我国航母舰载机首次着舰的关注,烘托当时紧张的氛围、胜利的喜悦等。增强新闻的现场感,增强感染力。侧面表现舰载机着舰风险极大、意义重大,从而突出了主题。
请从修辞手法角度赏析下列文字。
声如千骑疾,气卷万山来。惊心动魄的一幕出现了:9时08分,伴随震耳欲聋的喷气式发动机轰鸣声,眨眼之间,舰载机的两个主轮触到航母甲板上,机腹后方的尾钩牢牢地挂住了第二道阻拦索。刹那间,疾如闪电的舰载机在阻拦索系统的作用下,滑行数十米后,稳稳地停了下来。”
提示:本段文字主要运用了细节描写(“震耳欲聋”“轰鸣”“眨眼之间”“刹那间”“疾如闪电”等)和对偶、比喻的修辞手法(“声如千骑疾,气卷万山来”)。
运用细节描写,生动形象地描绘出战斗机着舰的情形。“震耳欲聋”“轰鸣”描绘出战斗机着舰时巨大的声音,“眨眼之间”“刹那间”“疾如闪电”等词描绘出战斗机着舰时震撼人心的速度,“牢牢地”“稳稳地”表现了战斗机着舰的安全和平衡。运用对偶和比喻的修辞手法,增强文章气势,生动形象地表现了战斗机着舰时的浩大声势,具有感染力。
1.叙事完整,铺排有序。《一着惊海天》对舰载机首架次着舰这一重大事件,从身着马甲的工作人员到飞行塔台内指挥人员的连续对话,整个过程都做了完整记录。记叙紧紧围绕着检查阻拦索、塔台广播、着舰指挥员引导、战斗机降落这一套程序来展开,条理清晰,毫无杂乱之感。
2.重点突出,主次分明。舰载战斗机着舰实验,是一个复杂危险的系统工程,要把这一切完全记录下来是不可能的,也是没有必要的。读者关注的是着舰能否成功。作者就是抓住了这一环节来叙写。这个关键环节就是塔台指挥和着舰动作。作者集中笔墨叙写了着舰过程的状态,将此过程清晰展现在读者面前。
3.文风平实,脉络直观。作为科技类文章,要让读者有更清晰最科学的把握,语言不能太含蓄。作者在叙写中紧要处的口令和动作都用实词准确阐述,为的是让读者直观易懂,让舰载战斗机这一实验事件更加平实,为读者解开高科技的神秘面纱。
本文抓住歼—15舰载战斗机首次成功着舰这一历史意义的时刻,采用现场特写的写法,生动再现了举世瞩目的我国航母舰载战斗机首次成功着舰那惊心动魄的一刻。表达了作者强烈的自豪感和对工作人员由衷的景仰之情。
八年级英语上册课件 篇4
【学习目标】
1.引导学生学习关于电视节目的常用词汇与句型,掌握mind和stand的用法。
2.通过交流使学生能听懂谈论电视节目的对话;学会用英语简单谈论几种电视节目。
3.引导学生通过开展小组学习活动,培养协作意识;并能学会询问他人对某事物的观点并会正确表达自己的看法。
【学习重点】
教会学生用所学的功能语言谈论电视节目。
【学习难点】
通过交流表达和听力训练,引入各种学习方法和策略来学习“Whatdo you think of…?”
Learning action tips:
Play the wonderful film clips that students most like to see, guide studentsto talk about the film types and contents they most like to see.
Task 1
Learning action tips:Previewthe words on Page33-34 in the word list. Students read the wordsby phonetic symbols, then underline new words in the text and mark the Chinese meaning.At last finish the task in 1a.
【Method coach】
▲Let\'s watch a talk show. 让我们看谈话节目吧。
让某人做某事:Let sb. do sth.
【导练】
( C )Let\'s ______ for a walk, shall we?
A.togoB.going
C.go
▲stand
(1)作不及物动词时,意为“站立”,构成stand up, 反义词为sit down。
(2)作及物动词时,意为“忍受,忍耐”,一般多用于否定句中,构成短语can\'t stand (doing) sth. 不能忍受(做)某事。如:情景导入 生成问题
1.T:Whatdo you think of …?
S:________________________________________________________________________
2.T:Whichcharacter do you like best?
S:________________________________________________________________________
自学互研 生成能力
Task1Let\'sread the new words and the phrases.
1.I can read.(我会读)
sitcom, soap opera, news,mind, stand, educational, plan, hope, discussion, happen, expect
2.I can write.(我会写)
翻译下列短语:
(1)访谈节目talk__show(2)肥皂剧soap__opera
(3)游戏节目game__show (4)体育节目sports__show
(5)才艺节目talent__show (6)从……学learn…from
(7)计划去做某事plan__to__do (8)期待去做某事expect__to__do__sth.
(9)调查出,弄清find__out (10)希望成为hope__to__be
(11)将来的某一天one__day
3.I can summarize.(我会总结)
你能总结介词mind和stand的用法吗?
mind doing sth.表示“介意做……”,stand doing sth.表示“忍受做某事”。
【拓展】
其他接doing的动词:
(1)enjoy doing sth. 意为喜欢做某事。
(2)practice doing sth.意为练习做某事。
(3)finish doing sth. 意为完成做某事。
(1)I don\'t mind watching(watch) soap operas.
(2)I can\'t stand closing(close)the window.
(3)I\'ll practice skating(skate)every day in window.
(4)You should finish doing(do)your homework first.
Task2Let\'slisten to the tape and finish 1b,2a,2b.
Task3Makeconversations and interview.
1.I can practice.(我会练)
A:What do you (1) want__to__watch(想看)?
B:What do you (2)think__of(认为)soap operas?
A:Oh, I (3)can\'t__stand__them(我不能忍受). I think soap operasare really boring.
B:Well, (4)what__about__game__shows(游戏节目呢)?
A:I like watching game shows. I watchit every night.
B:(5)Why__do__you__like__it?(为什么?)
A:Because I think game shows are moreeducational.
B: Then let\'s watch gameshows.
I can\'t stand soap operas.我无法忍受肥皂剧。
【导练】
My brother can\'t stand writing (write) diaries.
八年级英语上册课件 篇5
新目标英语八年级上Unit5教案
一、教学目标: 1.语言知识目标:
1)能掌握以下单词:sitcom, news, soap, educational, plan, hope, find out, discussion, stand, happen, may, expect 能掌握以下句型:
① What do you want to watch? ② What do you think of talk shows? ③ I can’t stand them.④ I don’t mind them.⑤ I like/love them./ I don’t like them.2)能了解以下语法:
动词不定式结构做动词的宾语;后面接动词不定式做宾语的动词。3)学会陈述自己的看法;学会谈论自己的喜好。2.情感态度价值观目标:
学会谈论流行文化,了解各类电视和电视节目的名称和自己的喜欢。注意引导学生们形成正确的文化观念,大力培养学生们的跨文化意义,形成自己独立的个性。
二、教学重难点 1.教学重点:
1)学习掌握各类电视和电视节目的名称。
2)掌握动词不定式结构做动词的宾语;了解后面接动词不定式做宾语的动词。
2.教学难点:
掌握动词不定式结构做动词的宾语;了解后面接动词不定式做宾语的动词。
三、教学过程 Step 1 Lead-in 学生们根据图片提示学习各类电视节目并且练习运用What do you think of…? Step 2 New words Learn the names of the TV shows.Step 3 Game 1.引导学生们看1a中的图片,根据提示依次说出每一部TV Show的名称。2.让学生们看图片及1a中的词汇,将图片与正确的词汇相连。3.Check the answers with the Ss.Step 4 Listening 1.T: Tell Ss to read the shows in the box.Make sure they know the meaning of the shows.2.Play the recording for the Ss to listen and number the shows1-4.3.Play the recording again.Check the answers with the Ss.Step 5 Pair work 1.Let Ss look at the pictures in the box.Then explain the meaning of each expression to the Ss.2.Let Ss read the conversation after the teacher.Then let Ss make their own conversation using the shows and expressions in the box.3.Let some pairs ask and answer about the shows.Step 6 Listening Work on 2a: 1.Read the shows in the box of 2a.Tell Ss to remember the information.2.Play the recording for the Ss to listen and number the TV shows [1-5].3.Play the recording again to check the on 2b: 1.Let Ss read the sentences below.Explain some main sentences for the Ss.Make sure they know what to do.2.Play the recording for the Ss to write the correct words in the blanks.3.Play the recording again to check the answers.Step 7 Pair work 1.Tell Ss ask and answer questions about the TV shows in 2a.They can use the information that is true for them.2.Let Ss read conversation after the teacher.3.Explain some main points for the Ss.4.Ss act the conversation in pairs.Ask some pairs to act out their conversations.
八年级英语上册课件 篇6
Unit 5 How much is it? 学习任务 1.能力目标 (1) 能够简单描述衣服、鞋子的大小,评论价格、颜色和款式,如:Its expensive\colourful. (2) 能够询问价格并做简略评价,如:How much is it? It’s…. (3) 能够听懂并发出与各种鞋类相关的简单指令,如:Put on your sneakers. 2.知识目标 (1) 掌握A 、B 部分read and write 中的单词和句子并能做到会听、说、读、写。 (2)听、说、认读A、B部分Let’s learn . Let’s talk 中的单词和句子. (3) 理解Let’s do. Let’s chant 等部分的内容. (4) 了解story time. Good to know 等部分的 内容. 3.情感、策略、文化等有关目标 (1)情感态度:能以得体的方式与人交际。 (2)文化目标: 了解英美两国与我国的衣物尺码标记的不同。 第一课时 课题:Unit 5 How much is it? A Lets learn Lets chant 教学重点:单词:colourful pretty cheap expensive 句子:It’s cheapprettyexpensivecolourful.来描述价格和颜色。 教学难点:单词expensive的读音。 根据实际情景运用本课时的四个形容词 教具准备:1、本课生词的单词卡片2、衣服的实物3、配套的教学VCD 4、配套的教学录音带5、课文配套挂图 教学过程: (一)复习(Revision) 1、Talk about the weather What’s the weather like today? What do you want to wear? 2、Show us your clothes学生们走到台前,介绍一下自己的衣服的颜色,样子。 T:“How much is it?Oh, it’s cheap.It’s expensive.It’s pretty.It’s colourful.” (二)呈现新课 (Presentation) 1、教师出示几件衣服的实物,并标出价格,说:“Guess, how much is it?” 引导学生回答价格,教师追问:“Is it cheap?Is it pretty?” 引导学生自己表述:“It’s cheapexpensivecolourfulpretty.” 教师根据学生的回答适时的出示相应的单词cheapexpensivecolourfulpretty.并进行带读,让学生进行认读练习。 2、教师出示Let’s learn部分的挂图。 T:“Look at that dress. It’s pretty. I want to buy it. It’s …yuan.” Students try to say like this. 3、观看VCD展示,跟读练习4、小组活动 学生两人一组。每个学生准备一些衣物单词的小卡片,在背面写出价格。 两人进行购物的对话练习。 教师先和一个学生进行示范(T: How much is that colourful dress? S: Very expensive. It’s …yuan. T: I want to buy it.) (三)趣味操练 (Practice) Guessing game: How much is it? 学生两人一组,运用一些衣物小卡片,猜测价格。 A: Guess, How much is it? B: It’s twenty yuan . A: No , too cheap. Guess again. B: … Let’s chant 听Let’s chant部分的歌谣,学生边说边两个人一组表演 (四)扩展性活动(Add-activities) Is it expensive? 每个小组拥有一套衣物、文具等物品的单词卡片和一套标有10-100元的几个卡片。 学生两个人一小组,一个学生任意搭配物品和价格,另一个学生进行描述:“It’s expensive…” 板书设计: Unit5 How much is it? Let’s learn:部分的挂图 第二课时 课题:Unit5 How much is it ? A Lets talk C Good to know 教学重点:句型:“Can I help you? How much is this skirt…? It’s colourful…” 教学难点:对新词的读音的指导和规范,如:“ninety-nine yuan.” 教具准备:1、本课生词的单词卡片 2、课文的配套挂图3、配套的教学VCD 4、相配套的教学录音带5、学生带来的衣服实物 教学过程 (一)复习(Revision) 1、let’s chant: 让学生边说,边两人一组表演歌谣 2、How much is your shirt? 教师找一名学生询问:Excuse me ,how much is your shirt? It’s …yuan . Is it cheap? Yes, it’s cheap and colouful. 学生们两人一组进行对话 (二)呈现新课 (Presentation) 1、教师在教室中挂上学生们带来的衣物,围绕教室挂满一圈。 2、教师和学生们进行对话的交流 T: Look at this shirt. It’s colourful. S: Yes, it’s pretty. T: How much is it? S: (请一个学生走到背面翻出价格)It’s one hundred yuan. It’s too expensive. 3、教师播放VCD,让学生观看故事,理解内容。 再看一遍,边看边模仿故事中人物的语气说一说。 分角色给VCD配音,小组练习和表演。 各小组展示 (三)趣味操练 (Practice) Group work:学生运用自己手中的卡片,进行对话和描述。 仿照Let’s talk部分中的对话。 (四)扩展性活动(Add-activities) 购物活动:教师发给每个学生1000元纸币(学生自己制作的),把教室分成四部分,组成四个服装店,每个店请一个学生扮演售货员。 让学生们仿照课文中的对话,进行购物活动。 活动完成后,小组中交流购物收获。运用How much is this skirt…? It’s cheap.等句子进行描述。 板书设计: Unit 5 How much is it? 第三课时 课题:Unit5 How much is it? A Read and write C Story time 教学重点:听说认读掌握生词:skirt shirt jacket dress T-shirt 教学难点:单词拼读;书写指导 教具准备:1、本课生词的单词卡片2、配套的教学VCD 3、相配套的教学录音带 4、学生自己的衣物5、课文主题图6、大小写字母卡片 教学过程: (一)复习(Revision) 1、Free talk What color do you like? What color is your …? 2、Let’s chant: B部分的Let’s chant.的歌谣,边说边出示单词。 (二)呈现新课 (Presentation) 1、教师准备好一些大小不一的衣服。说:“I think this skirt is pretty.”然后教师穿一下,说:“But it’s too big.”然后再拿起一件,说:“This one, it’s nice. It’s fits me well.” 2、教师请一个学生上来选衣服,指导学生运用句子:This shirt is …, but it’s too …. 3、然后多请上几个学生上来说。 4、小组活动 学生们把自己的衣服带来,在小组中每个学生轮流挑选衣服,在这一过程中运用This shirt is …, but it’s too …. 5、观看VCD,认读句子,让学生逐句认读,小组认读。 6、教师指读生词,让学生抢答认读。小组比赛拼读,抽查学生的拼读。 7、两人一小组,一个拼,一个写。单词的抄写练习。 8、出示句子的`句卡,然后学生试读,教师提示学生注意第一个单词第一个字母大写,提示学生注意标点和占格。 (三)趣味操练 (Practice) 1、拼一拼,猜一猜 教师拼一个单词,让学生迅速说出词。学生小组做游戏。 2、听一听,拼一拼 每个小组一套字母卡片,请一个学生说词,小组拼,比比谁最快。 3、教师请几个学生穿上不同大小的衣服(有的服装不合适),然后大家一起来评论一下。运用句子This shirt is …, but it’s too …. (四)扩展性活动(Add-activities) 每个学生设计一套衣服,给自己的和别人的娃娃穿上,然后进行比较。运用本单元学过的句型。 板书设计: Unit5 How much is it? 第四课时 课题:Unit 5 How much is it? B Lets learn Lets do C Lets sing 教学重点:理解掌握几种鞋的单词,学会用pair of …描述鞋的数量,并在实际情境中运用。 教学难点:在实际情境中运用词汇。 教具准备:本课生词的单词卡片;教学录音带;教学VCD;各种鞋的实物和图片。 教学过程: (一)复习(Revision) 1、A部分Let’s chant:学生跟录音说一说,演一演。 2、Let’s talk:学生说一说,并进行角色表演。 3、Guessing game 教师将各种标有价钱的衣服放到一个大储物袋中,让学生猜一猜里面有什么,学生猜对后,取出并描述一下大小、价钱等。 (二)呈现新课 (Presentation) 1、教师出示大挂图,让学生结合图说一说What can you see? 引出新的各种鞋的单词。 2、通过引入情景表演,描述图中的各种鞋,引出a pair of …。 3、学生进行情景表演练习,并熟悉新的单词及a pair of …的用法。 4、出示VCD,让学生观看VCD(关掉录音),根据故事的内容给VCD配音。 5、播放VCD,学生看VCD理解含义。 6、学生分角色跟读。 小组表演、各小组展示。 7、教师放录音,发布指令,教师根据录音内容举起相应的鞋图,并做出相应的动作。学生在教师的指导下做出相应的动作,熟悉各种鞋的名称。反复练习后学生边听录音做动作边试着发布指令。 (三)趣味操练 (Practice) 教师出示各种鞋的图片,然后将一图片藏起,并询问:What are they? 学生猜到后,找到该图片,用学过的知识描述被藏起来的鞋子。 (四)扩展性活动(Add-activities) 学生运用学过的知识描述自己的鞋或其他同学的鞋。 板书设计: Unit 5 How much is it? 第五课时 课题:Unit 5 How much is it? B Lets talk Group work C Lets check 教学重点:学习新句型:How much are they? A pair of …for …. 教学难点:在情景交际中正确使用How much are they? A pair of …for ….句型。 教具准备:1、单词卡片。2、衣物图片。3、教学VCD。4、教学录音带。 教学过程 (一)复习(Revision) 1、Let’s do:教师发出口令,学生听到口令后出示图片并做出相应的动作。 2、学生说唱本单元的歌谣。 (二)呈现新课 (Presentation) 1、教师出示Let&rsqu
八年级英语上册课件 篇7
Lesson 41
教学目标
学会12个月份、四季和顺数词的说法。学会表达日期。
教学用具
投影仪、录影机以及挂历和媒体设备等。
教学步骤
Step 1 Revision
老师可先做Duty Report, 除规定的内容外,必须让值日生回答以下几个问题: What day is it today / tomorrow?What day was it yesterday? What is the date today / tomorrow? What was the date yesterday? 然后将答案(完全形式和缩略形式)写在黑板上,并让学生视听,初步了解英文日期的表达与中文顺序的不同。然后全班问学生几个问题:What day is our National Day? October 1st. / Oct.1st. Which month is the Spring Festival in? Usually in February. Who / Whose mother / Whose father was born in February / April / May / September / October? 最好先找几个学生是在已学过的这几个月份出生的,或他们的父母是在这几个月份出生的,这样可先复习学过的几个月份。按季节做以下表格。先填出学过的季节和月份。学完生词后填满表格。
Step 2 Presentation
Learn and practise
Today we’ll study the first month, the third month, the sixth month, the seventh month, the eighth month, and the eleventh month of the year.
以下单词符合发音规律,请同学们自己拼读, 应该不会有太大的困难。
March June July
以下单词可迁移
autumn August February January September November, December
past last sing spring sea season 先让学生根据旧单词读出划线部分,然后再读整个单词。
这些单词大多数拼读较复杂,可让学生把这些单词先在本上抄一遍。
然后让学生练习自己的生日,每个人说出自己的生日。可两人互相问答,练习说自己的生日,父母的生日,朋友的生日等。
最后教师问学生:
T: How many months are there in a year?
Students: There are twelve months in a year.
T: What are they? Can you say them in English?
Ss: They are January, February, March, April, May, June, July, August, September, October, November and December.
让学生填满表格。
Ask and answer
T: There are four seasons in a year. They are spring, slimmer, autumn and winter. Do you know when spring/summer/autumn/winter is in China?
让学生根据上面填写的表格进行对话练习:
S1: When is spring in China?
S2: It’s from March to May.
S1: When is summer in China?
S2: It’s form June to August.
… …
Notes:
1. We say “autumn” in Britain, and say “fall” in American English.
2. When we say four seasons, we should use preposition “in”--in spring, in summer, in autumn/fall, in winter.
3. Preposition “on”
On Monday, On Tuesday, On Wednesday, On Thursday, On Friday, On Saturday, On Sunday
4. Preposition “at”
at 6 o clock, at 120 clock, at this time of year.
5. Preposition “in”
in the morning, in the afternoon, in the evening.
然后让学生自己完成课本上第2部分的练习。
Learn and practise
T: Do you remember the cardinal numbers that we have learnt before?
Let’s count them from one to thirty - one. OK! Could you please write them down in your note - books? Who wants to write the cardinal numbers on due blackboard?
要一个学生来写下以前所学的数词:
one, two, three, four, five, six, seven, eight, nine, ten, eleven, twelve … twenty-one … thirty thirty-one
然后问这个学生是否能把这些数词变成序数词:
first, second, third, fourth, fifth, sixth, seventh, eighth, ninth, tenth, eleventh, twelfth, … twenty-first … thirtieth, thirty-first
让学生注意黑体字显示的特殊变化。
Step 3 Practice
T: Which is the first month of the year?
Ss: January is the first month of the year.
T: Show them the answers
1. January is the first month of the year.
2. February is the second month of the year.
3. March is the third month of the year.
4. April is the fourth month of the year.
5. May is the fifth month of the year.
6. June is the sixth month of the year.
7 .July is the seventh month of the year.
8. August is the eighth month of the year.
9. September is the ninth month of the year.
10. October is the tenth month of the year.
11. November is the eleventh month of the year.
12. December is the twelfth month of the year.
用投影片练习以下日期:
两千零三年一月一日 New Year’s Day 日期January the first, two thousand and three / Jan. 1st, , 星期 Wednesday
二月 Spring Festival 日期星期
三月八日 Women’s Day 日期星期
五月一日 Labour Day 日期星期
六月一日 Children’s Day 日期星期
七月一日 Birthday of the Party 日期星期
八月一日 建军节 日期星期
九月十日 Teachers’ Day 日期星期
十二月二十五日 Christmas Day 日期星期
然后让学生练习关于询问最近几天的日期 (pair work),
S1: What day is it today?
S2: It’s November 3rd, /November the third, two thousand and two.
S1: What day was it yesterday?
S2: It was November 2nd, 2002.
… …
运用下面句型进行练习:
What day is it today / tomorrow? What day was it yesterday? What the date today / tomorrow? What was the date yesterday? When is your birthday? When is your father’s birthday / your mother’s birthday / your friend’s birthday?
让学生统计本组的,生日,看看那一个月份过生日的最多。
Step 4 Consolidation
编一段小短文,假定我们班一月份有五个同学过生日,说出这五个同学的生日,我们准备给他们集体过生日,要开一个生日Party, 定一个日期。并向全班宣布时间、地点。
Step 5 Exercises in class
Filling in the blanks: (keys in the following brackets)
1. New Year is on January, _________(the first)
2 .May the first is _________(Labor Day)
3. We love our teachers, we say Happy Teachers day on _________ (September, the tenth)
4. Flowers come out in________(spring)
5. Our second school - term lasts from ____ to ____. (February to July).
6. June the first is _________. (Children’s Day).
7. ______ is our National Day. (October, the first)
8.We can make a snow man in _________(winter)
9. September is the _________ month of year. (ninth)
10. ________, the twenty - fifth is Christmas Day. (December).
Homework
1. Recite the numbers, seasons and months.
2. Make five English sentences according to this lesson.
3. Do workbook.
The design of the blackboard
Lesson 42
教学目标
学会描述四季天气,信的基本写法。
教学用具
投影仪、录音机以及用过的外国的信封、信纸等。
教学步骤
Step 1 Revision
1. Duty Report: 让值日生报告,包括以下问题: What day is it today / tomorrow?What day was it yesterday? What is the date today / tomorrow? What was the date yesterday?等,并问学生What’s the weather like today? 老师可自己回答 It’s fine / cold.
2. Review the names of 12 months and four seasons.
Step 2 Presentation
1.通过叙述四季教新单词。如能配合媒体效果会更好。老师可看着媒体描述四季,让学生们注意听。
Spring is the first season of the year. The weather is very warm. 教warm, weather. I like spring best. Everything begins to turn green. Flowers come out. We can wear beautiful clothes, again. 教 come out. Summer is the warmest season of the year. It often rains, sometimes quite heavily, in the South. 教 heavily. The crops grow very quickly. 教 crop. Autumn is the busy season of the year. We often help them with their harvest. We really enjoy working on the farm. Because I like working better than having classes in the classroom. 教really. Winter is the coldest of the year. Old people don’t like it, but children like it. Because it sometime snows, sometimes very heavily. 教snow. Children can make a snowman. 教snowman.
引导学生讨论re-reading questions。先找一两个较好的同学说一说,再找几个小组的学生代表在全班展示。
2.观察信的格式
信纸的右上角写什么,称呼用什么标点,落款写什么。
阅读P.12, P.69和P.153三封信。让学生总结写信应有些什么套话。
老师可总结一封信的格式, 用你自己学校的地址。
观察SB P132 信封的写法。也可给让学生看一个真正的用过的信封、信纸。
让学生听录音,并跟读。
Step 3 Practise
1)让学生快速阅读这封信,Say something about the weather in spring, summer, autumn and winter in Hangzhou.
2)Say something about the four seasons in Beijing. 可以小组讨论后,代表发言,也可个人发言。
1. There are four seasons in Beijing.
2. It’s windy in spring. It’s warm in autumn.
It’s hot in summer. It’s cold in winter.
3. People like to have a picnic in spring.
They like to swim in summer.
They like to go outing in autumn.
They like to go skiing in winter.
Addition: How many kinds of sports do you know?
eg. running, skating, playing basketball, playing football, playing volleyball, the high jump, the long jump, relay race.
3)做Workbook
Step 4 Exercises in class
T: Let the students close their English books and fill in the missing words according to the letter. Then check the answers.
___1__Helen ,I___2___you are well. Thank you___3__your last letter. You__4___me about the weather here in China. There__5__four seasons in a year___6__spring,__7__, autumn and winter.
I think spring is the___8__season of the year. The weather___9___warmer, and the days___10__longer.___11__the fields everything begins to___12__. Trees__13__green, and flowers start to come__14__.
Summer__15___after spring. It is the__16__season. It often reins .sometimes quite__17___ The crops grow very quickly. Many people love this__18__of year, __19__it is good for___20__. I often go___21__, sometimes in a___22_near my home, and sometimes in a___23__. I enjoy it very___24__.
___25__is a busy season. The days get___26___and the nights get__27__. It is the harvest time, and all farmers are___28__.Often, we help them___29_the harvest.__30__month we helped them with the rice harvest. We really enjoyed__31__on the farm.
The coldest season of the year is winter. Some people___32___like winter, __33_I like it. Sometimes it snows, and the land is___34__white. Then we can play in the mow. I like to___35___snowmen.
How many seasons are__36___in your country? I___37__it is cold all the year __38__.There are not four seasons,__39__there?
_____40___
Wang Wei.
Keys: 1. Dear 2. hope 3. for 4. asked 5. are
6.here 7.summer 8.best 9.gets 10. get
11. In 12.grow 13.turn 14.out es
16.waimest 17.heavily 18. time 19.because 20.sports
21.swimming 22.lake 23.river 24.much 25.Autumn
26. shorter 27. longer 28. busy 29. with 30. Last
31.woiking 32.don’t 33.but 34.all 35.make
36.there 37.hear 38.round 39.are 40.Yours
Step 5 Homework
1. Read the letter fluently.
2. Make sentences with the useful expressions.
3. Try to write a short English letter.
假如Helen 给你也写了一封信,让你谈谈你家乡的四季,请你回一封信。
The design of the blackboard
Lesson 43-L44 教学设计方案
(一课时或两课时)
教学目标
掌握语音;谈谈自己对四季的看法,说说自己最喜欢那个季节,并说明理由。
教学用具
录影机、媒体设备。
教学步骤
Step 1 Revision
四季和12个月份。
Step 2 Presentation
老师朗读这些句子,朗读两遍,重读动词及反意部分。
It’s fine today, isn’t it? Yes, it is.
You’re from Japan, aren’t you? Yes, I am.
They are waiting, aren’t they? No, they aren’t.
He’s a middle school student, isn’t he? Yes, he is.
She is at home now, isn’t she? No, she isn’t. She is at school.
It was Sunday yesterday, wasn’t it? Yes, it was.
Jim knows the way Australians speak, doesn’t he? Yes, he is.
Han Meimei knows Jim a lot, doesn’t she?
They were watching TV yesterday evening, weren’t they? Yes, they were.
You like spring best, don’t you? No, I don’t. I like summer.
将这些句子用投影仪打出,让学生观察,并总结反意问句的构成,以及它的回答方式。
Step 3 Drill
然后可采用老师说主句部分,由学生练习缩略部分的方式练习。练熟后由学生说主句部分,老师说从句部分,直至练熟。也可在黑板上出一部分句子,写出主句部分,让学生写反意部分。目前只让学生练习前肯定后否定的反意问句,回答部分不必多花时间。
听录音,并跟读。
Step 4 Practise pair work
联系Part 2 可让学生自由发挥, 如两人谈谈北京的四季,和你家乡的季节,但主要练习反意问句及其回答。
教单词:true near nearly like unlike opposite
Step 5 Listen and repeat
Open your books and do Exercise One, Lesson 44
Pay attention to these pronunciations.
Read the words again.
T: Now let’s do Exercise Two. Listen to the tape and choose the correct answers on Page 134.
Then check the answers together.
Step 6 Consolidation
1.看图并谈谈北京的四季。一个学生可重点谈一个季节。练习Lesson 43 Part3.
2.让学生编一个对话,谈谈自己所喜爱的季节。引出一个十分有用的句型:That’s true.
仿照Lesson 44 Part3.
A: Which season do you like best, spring, summer, autumn or winter?
B: That’s an easy question. I think I like spring best.
A: Why?
B: Well, I like travelling. You can do a lot of sightseeing in spring. What about you?
A: Can you guess?
B: You like winter, don’t you?
A: Yes. How did you guess?
B: Because you like skiing.
A: That’s true, but I like summer better than winter.
B: Why?
A: Because I can have a long holiday in Summer then.
3.Listen Lesson 44 Part 4 Read.
把你听到的填写在下列表格中,对比中国,美国和澳大利亚。
Spring Weather Summer Weather Autumn Weather Winter Weather
China Mar- May Warm
England
Amer-ica Mar- May
Austra-lia
Keys
Spring Weather Summer Weather Autumn Weather Winter Weather
China Mar- May warmshort June-August hot Aug.-Nov. quite warm Dec.-Feb. very cold
England Mar.-- May longer than in China and USA Not too hot or too cold
Amer-ica Mar- May A nearly the same as China.
Austra-lia Dec.-Feb. The seasons are opposite of China. June-Aug.
Ask the students to look at the two pictures in students Book and describe the pictures in their own words.
Let them talk about the weather in China, in England, in the U. S. A. and in Australia.
4. Go over Checkpoint 11
A: Grammar
1. disjunctive questions 2. the prepositions: in, on and at
B: Useful expressions
1. turn green/yellow/… 2. this year/month/… 3. the next year/month/…
4. be different from 5. What is the date today? 6. What’s the weather like?
Step 7 Exercises in class
Listening practice.
Listen to a story and try to answer the following questions.
Everybody talks about weather. “Isn’t it a nice day?” “Do you think it will rain?” I think it s going to snow. These are common ways of starting a conversation in England.
Many people think that they can tell what the weather is going to be like. But they hardly ever agree with each other. One man may say, “Do you see it is cloudy in the east? It’s going to rain tomorrow.” Another man will say, “Yes, it’s cloudy in the east. We’re going to have fine weather tomorrow.”
People often look for the weather they want. When farmer needs water, he looks for something to tell himself that it's going to rain. When people play in a park on a rainy day, they are sure that the weather is going to be fine soon. They even sit eating their lunch while it rains.
Most people listen to what the weatherman says on the radio. But he doesn’t always tell them what they want to hear. Sometimes he makes a mistake, but he is still right more often than anyone else.
Questions.
1. How do English people start a conversation?
2. Do many of them think they can tell what the weather is going to be like?
3. Why do they hardly agree with each other?
4. What kind of weather do people think it’s going to be if they go out to play in a park in the rain?
5. Who is right more often about the weather?
Keys:
1. They usually talk about the weather.
2.Yes, they do.
3. Because each of them is so sure of himself that only he knows about the weather.
4. They think it s going to be fine.
5. The weatherman is.
Step 8 Homework
1. Make up a new dialogue according to Exercise Three.
2. Write about the weather of four seasons in China.
3. Read the text fluently and try to recite it.
4. Review Checkpoint 11 and the whole unit.
5. Go over disjunctive questions.
Blackboard Handwriting
八年级英语上册课件 篇8
3. I’m sorry, I can’t. 对不起,我不能。
6. (That’s) too bad. 那是太糟糕了。
7. How about you, Jenny?
8. What about you, Wilson?
那你呢,Wilson?
9. I’d love to. 我愿意。
为考试做准备。
11. 11. Sorry, I must ...
对不起,我必须......
13. I can’t. I might have to ...
16. I can’t either. 我也不能。
2. I’m sorry, I’m not free.
很抱歉,我没空。
I might have to ...我也许必须......
3. I’ll buy ... = I will buy...
5. (否定)I’m afraid not.
6. (肯定) I’m afraid so.
我恐怕是这样。
9. I’m not available. 我没空。
11. Good luck!祝你好运!
12. It sounds great. 这听起来太棒了。 (It sounds + adj.)
14. See you then./ See you. 再见。
I’d love to come.
That’s really too bad.
5. What’s today? 今天几号星期几?
3. is leaving (Be + Ving) “现在进行时表将来”将要离开
7. have a surprise party for sb. 为某人举办一场惊喜派对
10. any of ...
13. think of sth.考虑......
15. without + Ving/n./pron.
16. so that ...
18. hear from sb.
1. like ... a lot 非常喜欢......
2. help sb. to do sth.
8. bring sb. to sp.
1. thanks so much for doing sth. 非常感谢做某事
3. at the end of (this month )在(这个月)末
9. let me know (let sb. do sth.)让我知道
3. the opening of ... ......的开幕式
6. invite sb,. to do sth.
八年级英语上册课件 篇9
第三单元教学要点 教学要点: 一、本单元是一个说明文单元,《中国石拱桥》和《苏州园林》,《故宫博物院》是比较规范的说明文,其余则有一定的说明文性的小品。 二、本单元教学,要学生了解什么是说明文。 三、学习本单元,要理清说明文的顺序,了解常用的说明方法。 四、学习本单元后,要学生学习写作说明文。 教学时间:23课时 11 中国石拱桥 教学目的: 1.引导学生抓住中国石拱桥的特点。 2.列出文章结构,领会文章的内容。 3.激发学生热爱社会主义制度。 教学重难点: 1.重点:抓住中国石拱桥的特点,理清文章结构。 2.难点:课后思考练习题三,以形象的语言介绍一种事物。 学法指导:引导自读合作探究 教具准备: 小黑板 课时安排:3课时 教学过程: 第一 课 时 一.导入新课: 我们常常用桥梁来比喻友谊,因为是友谊就像桥一样把两个人连了起来。可见桥是在没有路的地方搭起来的路。根据史料和考察,在原始社会,我国就有了独木桥和数根圆木排拼而成的木梁桥。河北赵县的赵州桥是世界上第一座采用弓形拱的敞肩拱桥,欧洲在赵州桥建成七百年后才采用弓形拱的。我们的祖先的聪明才智值得我们每一位同学学习。 二.简介作者 茅以升是我国著名的桥梁专家、教育家、社会活动有。他主持设计的钱塘江大桥,是我国第一座由中国人自己设计的铁路公路两用桥;他还参加了新中国第一座现代化的大桥――武汉长江大桥的建造。本文最早以表于是1962年3月4 日《人民日报》,文笔通俗易懂,为读者介绍了中国石拱桥的特点,历史上的辉煌成就,及新中国成立后的发展,赞扬了我国劳动人民的聪明才智和社会主义制度的优越。 三.检查预习 1. 查字典,给加点的字注音。 弧形 拱桥 陡坡 匀称 惟妙惟肖 2. 读了本文,你了解中国石拱桥的特点以及赵州桥和卢沟桥的不同之处? 四. 初读课文,看看作者写出了石拱桥的什么特点。 1. 提示:请同学们找出哪些段落是写赵州桥的,哪些段落是写卢光沟桥的?联系课后思考练习题一,填空。 2. 学生读,填空,教师巡视指导。 3. 总结: 名称 位置 修建年月 结构特征 赵州桥 横跨在河上 修建于公元6左右。 1全桥只有一个大拱,长达37。4米。 2大拱的两肩上,各有两面三刀个小拱。3大拱由28道拱圈拼成。4全桥结构均匀。 卢沟桥 位于永定河上 修建于公元1189到1192年间 由11个半圆形石拱组成,每个石拱长度不一,自16米到21。6米,桥宽约8米,路面平坦,几乎与河面平行。每两个石拱之间有石砌桥墩,把11个石拱联成一个整体,是一座联拱石桥。 中国石拱桥的特点是形式优美,结构坚固,历史悠久。 第 二 课 时 一. 复习上节课学过的内容 1. 听写 2. 说说中国石拱桥的特点。 二. 细读全文,理解作者是怎样说明石拱桥的特点的。 1. 为了说明中国石拱桥的特点,作者举了两个例子,一个赵州桥,一个卢沟桥,这种说明方法叫做――举例子。 2. 在写赵州桥和卢沟桥时,作者列举了许多精确的数字,这种用数字来说明事物的方法叫做――列数字。 3. 为了让人们更清楚的认识中国石拱桥的特点,作者的语言很具有逻辑性,例如课文第五自然段,在写赵州桥时,先介绍了桥的长度、宽度、设计施工的精巧。再分四点用数字分别说明。层次性很强。 4. 作者在介绍两座桥时,既抓住了它们之间的共同点,又注意到了它们之间的不同点,请同学们找出来。(共同点是都介绍了地点,修建年代,及它们的结构特点。不同点是在介绍赵州桥时顺便说明了桥的设计者,介绍卢沟桥时作马可波罗的话来赞扬其高度的技术成就和艺术价值,还介绍了卢沟桥的的特殊历史价值。这不但使行文有所变化,而且增强了文章的可读性。) 三. 引导学生学习课文的最后两段。 1. 第九段写什么,怎样写?(文章又分三点解释了到得如此辉煌的建筑成就的原因。先写……再写……最后写……) 2. 最后一段写什么,怎样写?(介绍了解放后我国石拱桥的修建情况,列举了我国修建的世界最长的独拱石桥――“长虹大桥”、我国劳动人民独创的钢筋混凝土拱桥――(双曲拱桥等,说明了我国桥梁事业取得的巨大成绩。 四. 引导学生体会说明文行文简洁、用词准确的语言特点。(联系课后思考练习题二) 五. 联系课后思考练习题三,引导学生用打比方的方法,把要说明的事理解释清楚。(我们常说用白纸写黑字,黑板其实就是一张黑色的纸,用白色的笔来写。我们把一张黑色的纸放大,再挂起来,就是一张黑板。) 第 三 课 时 一、完成课后习题。 二、拓展延伸:形象的语言介绍一种事物 板书设计: 中国石拱桥 概括说明 一般:形式优美,结构坚固 中国:历史悠久,形式多样 具体说明(举例) 赵州桥:现存最古老 独拱---37.4米(当时最长) 设计科学,施工巧妙 卢沟桥:联拱---265米 石狮千态万状,惟妙惟肖 具有纪念意义 教学后记:学生对中国石拱桥的构造等的认识把握得较好,对文中的说明方法也掌握得不错; 但对说明文的多种顺序出现在同一篇文章中的形式认识有难度。 12 桥 之 美 教学目的: 流利、有感情地朗读课文,理解作者喜爱桥的原因。 品味本文优美而又富有意蕴的语言。 学习从某一角度欣赏艺术作品的方法。 教学重点难点 品味本文优美而又富有意蕴的语言。 课时安排 3课时。 课前准备 布置学生预习课文,会写生字、准确注音,排除字词障碍。 课前学生借助网络或图书,查阅一些有关的图片资料,或依据课文内容绘制几幅 图画。(体现桥与周围环境的和谐统一)准备录音带、录音机、微机或投影仪。 教学步骤 第 一 课 时 导人新课。 马致远的“小桥流水人家”让人联想到家的温馨;徐志摩的《再别康桥》使人产生无限的惆怅……在诗人的眼中“桥”是人性化的,是情感的载体;在画家的眼中,桥则别有一番 韵味。今天就让我们跟随当代画家吴冠中去感受“桥之美”。(板书课题,“美”字写大,突出一下) 教师配乐范读课文。 (要求:注意语气、语速、语调及重音的把握) 学生自由朗读课文,思考以下问题: (多媒体或投影显示问题组) 问题.a.在作者的眼中桥美在何处? b.为了说明桥之美作者主要举了哪些例子? c.联系课文说说怎样欣赏一幅画? 四人小组讨论明确: a.并不着眼于桥自身的结构美,而是缘于桥在不同环境中的多种多样的形式作用。 b.举了四个例子:乌镇苇丛上的石桥;江南乡间细柳下的石桥;水天间的长桥――颐和园的仿卢沟桥、苏州的宝带桥;形式独特的广西、云南、贵州山区的风雨桥。 c.画面的构成是否有块、线、面的搭配;画中的形象是否都能和周围的景物既形成对照又不失和谐。 ■研读与赏析 (过渡)通过阅读文章,我们不难看出作为画家,作者看桥淡化其结构、种类、功用,更重其美学价值。那么你能用优美的语言描绘文中你最欣赏的一幅画面吗7 重点研读第④小节。 (出示学生绘制的四幅图画) 四人小组讨论: a.说说四幅图中你最喜欢哪一幅,用生动的语言描绘画面并说说为什么喜欢? b.请有绘画天赋的同学点评。 c.我们应从哪些角度欣赏一幅艺术作品? 明确: a.◆厚厚实实的平面铺开的苇丛使空间显得狭窄拥挤,令人产生憋闷感;间或出现的石桥轮廓简单鲜明,能使空间陡然显得疏朗开阔,令人觉得神清气爽。 ◆细弱的`柳枝拂着桥身厚重坚硬的石块,这里有形体上的强弱、轻重、动静之分,有颜色上的对比,还有变(柳枝年年发新芽)与不变(桥能历久不变)之别,种种不同,归结起来,其实是阳刚与阴柔这两种美的类型的不同,因桥的轮廓精心设计而和谐统一。 ◆长桥一般建筑在比较宽阔的水面上,打破了背景的单调感。桥是人们劳动的成果,出现在苍茫水面上的长桥,是人类创造力的体现。整个环境似乎有了灵气和生命。 ◆桥面上盖有廊和亭的桥,给人安闲、自在的感觉,这种感觉恰好与险峻的山峰、桥下的急流给人的感觉形成对照。 b.点评语言、欣赏的角度。 c.从色彩的搭配、画面构成(块、线、面)、景物的选择(强弱、明暗、动静等)是否对立统一……角度来判断。 美句赏析。 (过渡)吴冠中以他画家的真知灼见,不但告知了我们如何用“美学”的眼光来重新审视事物,而且他还用蕴涵丰富的语言引起我们强烈的感情上的共鸣。 a.找出意蕴丰富的语句,体味句子的情昧。 b.先四人小组讨论,再让小组派代表发言。 重点赏析以下语句: ◆茅盾故乡乌镇的小河两岸都是密密的芦苇,真是密不透风,每当其间显现一座石桥时,仿佛发闷的苇丛做了一次深呼吸,透了一口舒畅的气。 ◆早春天气,江南乡间石桥头细柳飘丝,那纤细的游丝拂着桥身坚硬的石块,即使碰不见晓风残月,也令画家销魂! ◆无论是木桥还是石桥,其身段的纵横与桥下的水波协同谱成形与色的乐曲。. ◆田野无声,画家们爱于无声处静听桥之歌唱,他们寻桥,仿佛孩子们寻找热闹。 (过渡)我们从《桥之美》中,体会到了桥的美感,真是赏心悦目。同是写桥的文章,《中国石拱桥》与之有什么不同之处呢? 课堂小结 同学们,今天我们在画家吴冠中的带领下,一起领略了桥的风采,生活中有多少美不胜收的景致,或纤弱或雄壮或含蓄……让我们练就一双慧眼去发现、去鉴赏这大干世界吧! 第 二 课 时 一、完成课后习题。 二、拓展延伸 比较本文与《中国石拱桥》在内容和写法上有何不同? 明确:本文是一篇带有说明性质的小品文。它的说明性体现在文中先点明在画家眼里桥美在何处,随后举了一些具体的例子。但是与《中国石拱桥》这种较为规范的说明文不同的是,在举例时,作者并不是用科学、平实的语言向读者解说,而是或描写景物,或抒发感情,文字极富表现力和感染力。 板书设
八年级英语上册课件 篇10
教案一:Unit 1 Where did you go on vacation?
1. 教学目标:
a. 学习并掌握目标词汇和短语,如vacation, activity, tourist, guide等。
b. 学习并掌握目标句型,如Where did you go? I went to…
c. 学会用过去式叙述过去发生的事情。
2. 教学准备:
a. PPT展示相关图片和单词。
b. 学生练习册。
c. 录音机和磁带。
3. 教学步骤:
a. 导入:利用PPT呈现一些度假图片,引导学生回忆并复习相关单词和短语。
b. 新词学习:教师通过幻灯片和板书介绍并讲解新单词和短语,并提供相关例句。
c. 句型学习:教师通过示范并操练句型“Where did you go? I went to…”,确保学生能正确运用。
d. 练习册:学生完成练习册相关练习,教师巡视并纠正错误。
e. 听力练习:播放录音,让学生根据听到的内容选择正确的答案。
f. 拓展活动:以小组为单位,要求学生同伴之间互相询问对方的假期并作简短介绍。
g. 总结与巩固:教师再次复习已学内容,巩固学生的知识。
h. 作业布置:布置相关作业,如复习单词和短语,完成练习册等。
4. 教学评价:
a. 能正确运用目标词汇和短语进行交流。
b. 能够运用句型“Where did you go? I went to…”进行简单的对话。
c. 能听懂简短的听力材料并选择正确的答案。
教案二:Unit 2 How often do you exercise?
1. 教学目标:
a. 学习并掌握目标词汇和短语,如exercise, often, sometimes, rarely等。
b. 学习并掌握目标句型,如How often do you…? I … every…
c. 学会用正确的频率副词表达自己的活动频率。
2. 教学准备:
a. PPT展示相关图片和单词。
b. 学生练习册。
c. 实物道具,如计数器,用来演示不同活动的频率。
3. 教学步骤:
a. 导入:利用PPT呈现一些运动图片,引导学生回忆并复习相关单词和短语。
b. 新词学习:教师通过幻灯片和板书介绍并讲解新单词和短语,并提供相关例句。
c. 句型学习:教师通过示范并操练句型“How often do you…? I … every…”,确保学生能正确运用。
d. 练习册:学生完成练习册相关练习,教师巡视并纠正错误。
e. 实物演示:教师使用计数器和实物道具演示不同活动的频率,引导学生用正确的频率副词表达自己的活动频率。
f. 拓展活动:以小组为单位,学生互相交流关于自己日常活动频率的话题,并写下来。
g. 总结与巩固:教师再次复习已学内容,巩固学生的知识。
h. 作业布置:布置相关作业,如复习单词和短语,完成练习册等。
4. 教学评价:
a. 能正确运用目标词汇和短语进行交流。
b. 能够运用句型“How often do you…? I … every…”表达自己的活动频率。
c. 能根据实物演示理解不同活动的频率,进行表达。